Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1 | ---------------------- |
| 2 | HAProxy |
| 3 | Configuration Manual |
| 4 | ---------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | 21475e3 | 2010-05-23 08:46:08 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5 | version 1.5 |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6 | willy tarreau |
Willy Tarreau | ffb8947 | 2012-05-14 07:26:56 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7 | 2012/05/13 |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8 | |
| 9 | |
| 10 | This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version |
| 11 | specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 12 | documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual. |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 13 | The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate |
| 14 | through the document. |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 15 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 16 | Note to documentation contributors : |
| 17 | This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of |
| 18 | spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly |
| 19 | so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be |
| 20 | printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 21 | ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also |
| 22 | sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3 |
| 23 | closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between |
| 24 | inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections, |
| 25 | please update the summary below for easier searching. |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 26 | |
| 27 | |
| 28 | Summary |
| 29 | ------- |
| 30 | |
| 31 | 1. Quick reminder about HTTP |
| 32 | 1.1. The HTTP transaction model |
| 33 | 1.2. HTTP request |
| 34 | 1.2.1. The Request line |
| 35 | 1.2.2. The request headers |
| 36 | 1.3. HTTP response |
| 37 | 1.3.1. The Response line |
| 38 | 1.3.2. The response headers |
| 39 | |
| 40 | 2. Configuring HAProxy |
| 41 | 2.1. Configuration file format |
| 42 | 2.2. Time format |
Patrick Mezard | 35da19c | 2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 43 | 2.3. Examples |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 44 | |
| 45 | 3. Global parameters |
| 46 | 3.1. Process management and security |
| 47 | 3.2. Performance tuning |
| 48 | 3.3. Debugging |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 49 | 3.4. Userlists |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 50 | 3.5. Peers |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 51 | |
| 52 | 4. Proxies |
| 53 | 4.1. Proxy keywords matrix |
| 54 | 4.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference |
| 55 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c6df066 | 2010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 56 | 5. Server and default-server options |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 57 | |
| 58 | 6. HTTP header manipulation |
| 59 | |
Cyril Bonté | 7d38afb | 2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 60 | 7. Using ACLs and pattern extraction |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 61 | 7.1. Matching integers |
| 62 | 7.2. Matching strings |
| 63 | 7.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes) |
Willy Tarreau | ceb4ac9 | 2012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 64 | 7.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 65 | 7.5. Available matching criteria |
| 66 | 7.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below |
| 67 | 7.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 |
| 68 | 7.5.3. Matching at Layer 7 |
| 69 | 7.6. Pre-defined ACLs |
| 70 | 7.7. Using ACLs to form conditions |
Cyril Bonté | 7d38afb | 2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 71 | 7.8. Pattern extraction |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 72 | |
| 73 | 8. Logging |
| 74 | 8.1. Log levels |
| 75 | 8.2. Log formats |
| 76 | 8.2.1. Default log format |
| 77 | 8.2.2. TCP log format |
| 78 | 8.2.3. HTTP log format |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 79 | 8.2.4. Custom log format |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 80 | 8.3. Advanced logging options |
| 81 | 8.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests |
| 82 | 8.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate |
| 83 | 8.3.3. Raising log level upon errors |
| 84 | 8.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections |
| 85 | 8.4. Timing events |
| 86 | 8.5. Session state at disconnection |
| 87 | 8.6. Non-printable characters |
| 88 | 8.7. Capturing HTTP cookies |
| 89 | 8.8. Capturing HTTP headers |
| 90 | 8.9. Examples of logs |
| 91 | |
| 92 | 9. Statistics and monitoring |
| 93 | 9.1. CSV format |
| 94 | 9.2. Unix Socket commands |
| 95 | |
| 96 | |
| 97 | 1. Quick reminder about HTTP |
| 98 | ---------------------------- |
| 99 | |
| 100 | When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are |
| 101 | fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria |
| 102 | on almost anything found in the contents. |
| 103 | |
| 104 | However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are |
| 105 | formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write |
| 106 | correct rules and to debug existing configurations. |
| 107 | |
| 108 | |
| 109 | 1.1. The HTTP transaction model |
| 110 | ------------------------------- |
| 111 | |
| 112 | The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 113 | to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 114 | from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the |
| 115 | connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request |
| 116 | will involve a new connection : |
| 117 | |
| 118 | [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ... |
| 119 | |
| 120 | In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection |
| 121 | establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed |
| 122 | by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content |
| 123 | length. |
| 124 | |
| 125 | Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it |
| 126 | to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode |
| 127 | however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each |
| 128 | response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special |
| 129 | header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode : |
| 130 | |
| 131 | [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ... |
| 132 | |
| 133 | Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing |
| 134 | power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode, |
| 135 | but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to |
Patrick Mezard | 9ec2ec4 | 2010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 136 | a smaller value. |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 137 | |
| 138 | A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses |
| 139 | keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the |
| 140 | second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a |
| 141 | page : |
| 142 | |
| 143 | [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ... |
| 144 | |
| 145 | This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network |
| 146 | latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not |
| 147 | correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with |
| 148 | the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the |
Cyril Bonté | 78caf84 | 2010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 149 | server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received. |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 150 | |
Patrick Mezard | 9ec2ec4 | 2010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 151 | By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent |
| 152 | connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards |
| 153 | everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once |
| 154 | established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server |
| 155 | sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections |
| 156 | while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after |
| 157 | another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both |
| 158 | sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option |
| 159 | http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close |
| 160 | mode. |
| 161 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 162 | |
| 163 | 1.2. HTTP request |
| 164 | ----------------- |
| 165 | |
| 166 | First, let's consider this HTTP request : |
| 167 | |
| 168 | Line Contents |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 169 | number |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 170 | 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1 |
| 171 | 2 Host: www.mydomain.com |
| 172 | 3 User-agent: my small browser |
| 173 | 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif |
| 174 | 5 Accept: image/png |
| 175 | |
| 176 | |
| 177 | 1.2.1. The Request line |
| 178 | ----------------------- |
| 179 | |
| 180 | Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields : |
| 181 | |
| 182 | - a METHOD : GET |
| 183 | - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 |
| 184 | - a version tag : HTTP/1.1 |
| 185 | |
| 186 | All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces), |
| 187 | which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns |
| 188 | followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and |
| 189 | is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it |
| 190 | desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to |
| 191 | the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression. |
| 192 | |
| 193 | The URI itself can have several forms : |
| 194 | |
| 195 | - A "relative URI" : |
| 196 | |
| 197 | /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 |
| 198 | |
| 199 | It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is |
| 200 | received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies. |
| 201 | |
| 202 | - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" : |
| 203 | |
| 204 | http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 |
| 205 | |
| 206 | It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host |
| 207 | name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then |
| 208 | a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part. |
| 209 | This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1 |
| 210 | must accept this form too. |
| 211 | |
| 212 | - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS |
| 213 | method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's |
| 214 | capabilities. |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 215 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 216 | - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80 |
| 217 | This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP |
| 218 | tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for |
| 219 | other protocols too. |
| 220 | |
| 221 | In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question |
| 222 | mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects |
| 223 | on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string". |
| 224 | It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very |
| 225 | specific to the language, framework or application in use. |
| 226 | |
| 227 | |
| 228 | 1.2.2. The request headers |
| 229 | -------------------------- |
| 230 | |
| 231 | The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the |
| 232 | beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally, |
| 233 | an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values. |
| 234 | Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the |
| 235 | values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly |
| 236 | encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if |
| 237 | the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5 |
| 238 | define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header. |
| 239 | |
| 240 | Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and |
| 241 | their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the |
| 242 | "Connection:" header). |
| 243 | |
| 244 | The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say |
| 245 | that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed |
| 246 | is one valid form of empty line. |
| 247 | |
| 248 | Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing |
| 249 | headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry |
| 250 | about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an |
| 251 | application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things. |
| 252 | |
| 253 | Important note: |
| 254 | As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks |
| 255 | in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This |
| 256 | is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work |
| 257 | correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs. |
| 258 | |
| 259 | |
| 260 | 1.3. HTTP response |
| 261 | ------------------ |
| 262 | |
| 263 | An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP |
| 264 | messages. Let's consider this HTTP response : |
| 265 | |
| 266 | Line Contents |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 267 | number |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 268 | 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK |
| 269 | 2 Content-length: 350 |
| 270 | 3 Content-Type: text/html |
| 271 | |
Willy Tarreau | 816b979 | 2009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 272 | As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status |
| 273 | codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the |
| 274 | response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to |
Willy Tarreau | 5843d1a | 2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 275 | continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response |
| 276 | the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message |
| 277 | following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be |
| 278 | sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled |
| 279 | (1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to |
| 280 | correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As |
| 281 | such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly |
| 282 | state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing |
| 283 | over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as |
| 284 | if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional |
| 285 | information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to. |
Willy Tarreau | 816b979 | 2009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 286 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 287 | |
| 288 | 1.3.1. The Response line |
| 289 | ------------------------ |
| 290 | |
| 291 | Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields : |
| 292 | |
| 293 | - a version tag : HTTP/1.1 |
| 294 | - a status code : 200 |
| 295 | - a reason : OK |
| 296 | |
| 297 | The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status : |
Willy Tarreau | 816b979 | 2009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 298 | - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101) |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 299 | - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206) |
| 300 | - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304) |
| 301 | - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404) |
| 302 | - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503) |
| 303 | |
| 304 | Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 305 | "reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 306 | found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established |
| 307 | messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found", |
| 308 | or "Authentication Required". |
| 309 | |
| 310 | Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself : |
| 311 | |
| 312 | Code When / reason |
| 313 | 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests |
| 314 | 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code |
| 315 | 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code |
| 316 | 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code |
| 317 | 400 for an invalid or too large request |
| 318 | 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when |
| 319 | accessing the stats page) |
| 320 | 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter |
| 321 | 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete |
| 322 | 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a |
| 323 | memory allocation failure, which should never happen |
| 324 | 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or |
| 325 | when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response. |
| 326 | 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to |
| 327 | monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition |
| 328 | 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds |
| 329 | |
| 330 | The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section |
| 331 | 4.2). |
| 332 | |
| 333 | |
| 334 | 1.3.2. The response headers |
| 335 | --------------------------- |
| 336 | |
| 337 | Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses |
| 338 | the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more |
| 339 | details. |
| 340 | |
| 341 | |
| 342 | 2. Configuring HAProxy |
| 343 | ---------------------- |
| 344 | |
| 345 | 2.1. Configuration file format |
| 346 | ------------------------------ |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 347 | |
| 348 | HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters : |
| 349 | |
| 350 | - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence |
| 351 | - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters |
| 352 | - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen", |
| 353 | "frontend" and "backend". |
| 354 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 355 | The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword |
| 356 | referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters |
| 357 | delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 358 | preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 359 | escaped by doubling them. |
| 360 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 361 | |
| 362 | 2.2. Time format |
| 363 | ---------------- |
| 364 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 365 | Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 366 | values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated |
| 367 | otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the |
| 368 | numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated |
| 369 | for every keyword. Supported units are : |
| 370 | |
| 371 | - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second |
| 372 | - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default. |
| 373 | - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms |
| 374 | - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms |
| 375 | - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms |
| 376 | - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms |
| 377 | |
| 378 | |
Patrick Mezard | 35da19c | 2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 379 | 2.3. Examples |
| 380 | ------------- |
| 381 | |
| 382 | # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all |
| 383 | # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a |
| 384 | # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000 |
| 385 | global |
| 386 | daemon |
| 387 | maxconn 256 |
| 388 | |
| 389 | defaults |
| 390 | mode http |
| 391 | timeout connect 5000ms |
| 392 | timeout client 50000ms |
| 393 | timeout server 50000ms |
| 394 | |
| 395 | frontend http-in |
| 396 | bind *:80 |
| 397 | default_backend servers |
| 398 | |
| 399 | backend servers |
| 400 | server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32 |
| 401 | |
| 402 | |
| 403 | # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but |
| 404 | # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode. |
| 405 | global |
| 406 | daemon |
| 407 | maxconn 256 |
| 408 | |
| 409 | defaults |
| 410 | mode http |
| 411 | timeout connect 5000ms |
| 412 | timeout client 50000ms |
| 413 | timeout server 50000ms |
| 414 | |
| 415 | listen http-in |
| 416 | bind *:80 |
| 417 | server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32 |
| 418 | |
| 419 | |
| 420 | Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with: |
| 421 | |
Willy Tarreau | ccb289d | 2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 422 | $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c |
Patrick Mezard | 35da19c | 2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 423 | |
| 424 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 425 | 3. Global parameters |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 426 | -------------------- |
| 427 | |
| 428 | Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They |
| 429 | are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some |
| 430 | of them have command-line equivalents. |
| 431 | |
| 432 | The following keywords are supported in the "global" section : |
| 433 | |
| 434 | * Process management and security |
| 435 | - chroot |
| 436 | - daemon |
| 437 | - gid |
| 438 | - group |
| 439 | - log |
Joe Williams | df5b38f | 2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 440 | - log-send-hostname |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 441 | - nbproc |
| 442 | - pidfile |
| 443 | - uid |
| 444 | - ulimit-n |
| 445 | - user |
Willy Tarreau | fbee713 | 2007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 446 | - stats |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 48cb2ae | 2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 447 | - node |
| 448 | - description |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 449 | - unix-bind |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 450 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 451 | * Performance tuning |
| 452 | - maxconn |
Willy Tarreau | 81c25d0 | 2011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 453 | - maxconnrate |
Willy Tarreau | ff4f82d | 2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 454 | - maxpipes |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 455 | - noepoll |
| 456 | - nokqueue |
| 457 | - nopoll |
| 458 | - nosepoll |
Willy Tarreau | ff4f82d | 2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 459 | - nosplice |
Willy Tarreau | fe255b7 | 2007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 460 | - spread-checks |
Willy Tarreau | 27a674e | 2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 461 | - tune.bufsize |
Willy Tarreau | 43961d5 | 2010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 462 | - tune.chksize |
Willy Tarreau | ac1932d | 2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 463 | - tune.http.maxhdr |
Willy Tarreau | a0250ba | 2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 464 | - tune.maxaccept |
| 465 | - tune.maxpollevents |
Willy Tarreau | 27a674e | 2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 466 | - tune.maxrewrite |
Willy Tarreau | bd9a0a7 | 2011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 467 | - tune.pipesize |
Willy Tarreau | e803de2 | 2010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 468 | - tune.rcvbuf.client |
| 469 | - tune.rcvbuf.server |
| 470 | - tune.sndbuf.client |
| 471 | - tune.sndbuf.server |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 472 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 473 | * Debugging |
| 474 | - debug |
| 475 | - quiet |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 476 | |
| 477 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 478 | 3.1. Process management and security |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 479 | ------------------------------------ |
| 480 | |
| 481 | chroot <jail dir> |
| 482 | Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before |
| 483 | dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown |
| 484 | vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the |
| 485 | attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started |
| 486 | with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both |
| 487 | empty and unwritable to anyone. |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 488 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 489 | daemon |
| 490 | Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of |
| 491 | operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be |
| 492 | disabled by the command line "-db" argument. |
| 493 | |
| 494 | gid <number> |
| 495 | Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group |
| 496 | ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must |
| 497 | be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges. |
| 498 | See also "group" and "uid". |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 499 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 500 | group <group name> |
| 501 | Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group. |
| 502 | See also "gid" and "user". |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 503 | |
Willy Tarreau | f7edefa | 2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 504 | log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]] |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 505 | Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They |
| 506 | will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies |
Robert Tsai | 81ae195 | 2007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 507 | configured with "log global". |
| 508 | |
| 509 | <address> can be one of: |
| 510 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 511 | - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If |
Robert Tsai | 81ae195 | 2007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 512 | no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog |
| 513 | port). |
| 514 | |
David du Colombier | 24bb5f5 | 2011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 515 | - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If |
| 516 | no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog |
| 517 | port). |
| 518 | |
Robert Tsai | 81ae195 | 2007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 519 | - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind |
| 520 | considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside |
| 521 | the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately |
| 522 | writeable). |
| 523 | |
| 524 | <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities : |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 525 | |
| 526 | kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news |
| 527 | uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2 |
| 528 | local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7 |
| 529 | |
| 530 | An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default, |
Willy Tarreau | f7edefa | 2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 531 | all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a |
| 532 | severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum |
| 533 | level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level |
| 534 | than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending |
| 535 | "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations. |
| 536 | Eight levels are known : |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 537 | |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 538 | emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 539 | |
Joe Williams | df5b38f | 2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 540 | log-send-hostname [<string>] |
| 541 | Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter |
| 542 | is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname |
| 543 | of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an |
| 544 | intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in |
| 545 | the logs. |
| 546 | |
Kevinm | 48936af | 2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000 | [diff] [blame] | 547 | log-tag <string> |
| 548 | Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the |
| 549 | program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". |
| 550 | Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes |
| 551 | running on the same host. |
| 552 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 553 | nbproc <number> |
| 554 | Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon" |
| 555 | mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode |
| 556 | of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per |
| 557 | process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES |
| 558 | IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon". |
| 559 | |
| 560 | pidfile <pidfile> |
| 561 | Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to |
| 562 | the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user |
| 563 | starting the process. See also "daemon". |
| 564 | |
Willy Tarreau | fbee713 | 2007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 565 | stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>] |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 566 | [level <level>] |
Willy Tarreau | 6162db2 | 2009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 567 | |
Willy Tarreau | fbee713 | 2007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 568 | Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously |
| 569 | existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 570 | will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be |
Willy Tarreau | 6162db2 | 2009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 571 | issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details. |
| 572 | |
| 573 | An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of |
| 574 | the commands that can be issued on the socket : |
| 575 | - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be |
| 576 | read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it |
| 577 | is not easy to restrict access to the socket. |
| 578 | |
| 579 | - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can |
Willy Tarreau | 3c92c5f | 2011-08-28 09:45:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 580 | be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max |
Willy Tarreau | 6162db2 | 2009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 581 | counters). |
| 582 | |
| 583 | - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear |
| 584 | all counters). |
Willy Tarreau | a8efd36 | 2008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 585 | |
| 586 | On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this |
| 587 | socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and |
| 588 | group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to |
| 589 | restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode" |
| 590 | keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on |
| 591 | the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the |
| 592 | user the process is started with. |
Willy Tarreau | fbee713 | 2007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 593 | |
| 594 | stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds> |
| 595 | The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible |
| 596 | to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in |
Willy Tarreau | befdff1 | 2007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 597 | milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. |
Willy Tarreau | fbee713 | 2007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 598 | |
| 599 | stats maxconn <connections> |
| 600 | By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is |
| 601 | possible to change this value with "stats maxconn". |
| 602 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 603 | uid <number> |
| 604 | Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID |
| 605 | is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must |
| 606 | be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another |
| 607 | one. See also "gid" and "user". |
| 608 | |
| 609 | ulimit-n <number> |
| 610 | Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By |
| 611 | default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this |
| 612 | option. |
| 613 | |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 614 | unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ] |
| 615 | [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ] |
| 616 | |
| 617 | Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements. |
| 618 | This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce |
| 619 | the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are |
| 620 | also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket |
| 621 | path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another |
| 622 | component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots |
| 623 | itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid> |
| 624 | all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If |
| 625 | both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the |
| 626 | "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings. |
| 627 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 628 | user <user name> |
| 629 | Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd. |
| 630 | See also "uid" and "group". |
| 631 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 48cb2ae | 2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 632 | node <name> |
| 633 | Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names. |
| 634 | |
| 635 | This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or |
| 636 | servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all |
| 637 | nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the |
| 638 | traffic. |
| 639 | |
| 640 | description <text> |
| 641 | Add a text that describes the instance. |
| 642 | |
| 643 | Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example) |
| 644 | and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using |
| 645 | "<" and ">" characters. |
| 646 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 647 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 648 | 3.2. Performance tuning |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 649 | ----------------------- |
| 650 | |
| 651 | maxconn <number> |
| 652 | Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It |
| 653 | is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting |
| 654 | connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is |
| 655 | automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". |
| 656 | |
Willy Tarreau | 81c25d0 | 2011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 657 | maxconnrate <number> |
| 658 | Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>. |
| 659 | Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be |
| 660 | used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is |
| 661 | important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure, |
| 662 | as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the |
| 663 | limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some |
| 664 | value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve |
| 665 | fairness. |
| 666 | |
Willy Tarreau | ff4f82d | 2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 667 | maxpipes <number> |
| 668 | Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes |
| 669 | are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file |
| 670 | descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default |
| 671 | value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages. |
| 672 | The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back |
| 673 | to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance. |
| 674 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 675 | noepoll |
| 676 | Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is |
| 677 | equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system |
| 678 | used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll". |
| 679 | |
| 680 | nokqueue |
| 681 | Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is |
| 682 | equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system |
| 683 | used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll". |
| 684 | |
| 685 | nopoll |
| 686 | Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the |
| 687 | command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select". |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 688 | It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 689 | platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and |
| 690 | "nokqueue". |
| 691 | |
| 692 | nosepoll |
| 693 | Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It |
| 694 | is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system |
| 695 | used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll". |
| 696 | |
Willy Tarreau | ff4f82d | 2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 697 | nosplice |
| 698 | Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is |
| 699 | equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied |
| 700 | using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 701 | limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between |
Willy Tarreau | ff4f82d | 2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 702 | 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not |
| 703 | be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in |
| 704 | case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and |
| 705 | "option splice-response". |
| 706 | |
Willy Tarreau | fe255b7 | 2007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 707 | spread-checks <0..50, in percent> |
| 708 | Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact |
| 709 | intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same |
| 710 | physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add |
| 711 | some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between |
| 712 | 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0. |
| 713 | |
Willy Tarreau | 27a674e | 2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 714 | tune.bufsize <number> |
| 715 | Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more |
| 716 | sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some |
| 717 | applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and |
| 718 | can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this |
| 719 | from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as |
| 720 | statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage, |
| 721 | possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn |
| 722 | parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. |
| 723 | |
Willy Tarreau | 43961d5 | 2010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 724 | tune.chksize <number> |
| 725 | Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help |
| 726 | find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply |
| 727 | more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at |
| 728 | build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better |
| 729 | checks whenever possible. |
| 730 | |
Willy Tarreau | ac1932d | 2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 731 | tune.http.maxhdr <number> |
| 732 | Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a |
| 733 | number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is |
| 734 | rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses |
| 735 | are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough |
| 736 | for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the |
| 737 | same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow |
| 738 | a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each |
| 739 | new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this |
| 740 | limit too high. |
| 741 | |
Willy Tarreau | a0250ba | 2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 742 | tune.maxaccept <number> |
| 743 | Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on |
| 744 | a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates, |
| 745 | while lower values give higher priority to already established connections. |
Willy Tarreau | f49d1df | 2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 746 | This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in |
Willy Tarreau | a0250ba | 2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 747 | multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process |
| 748 | wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a |
Willy Tarreau | f49d1df | 2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 749 | part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables |
Willy Tarreau | a0250ba | 2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 750 | the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value. |
| 751 | |
| 752 | tune.maxpollevents <number> |
| 753 | Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to |
| 754 | the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It |
| 755 | has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease |
| 756 | latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200 |
| 757 | tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth. |
| 758 | |
Willy Tarreau | 27a674e | 2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 759 | tune.maxrewrite <number> |
| 760 | Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is |
| 761 | used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never |
| 762 | fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of |
| 763 | bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large |
| 764 | numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large |
| 765 | requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers |
| 766 | to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it |
| 767 | to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is |
| 768 | larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing |
| 769 | bufsize. |
| 770 | |
Willy Tarreau | bd9a0a7 | 2011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 771 | tune.pipesize <number> |
| 772 | Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes |
| 773 | are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing, |
| 774 | it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is |
| 775 | suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are |
| 776 | performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must |
| 777 | not be changed if impacts are not understood. |
| 778 | |
Willy Tarreau | e803de2 | 2010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 779 | tune.rcvbuf.client <number> |
| 780 | tune.rcvbuf.server <number> |
| 781 | Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side |
| 782 | to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends |
| 783 | and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets |
| 784 | the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory. |
| 785 | However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in |
| 786 | order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts |
| 787 | of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though. |
| 788 | |
| 789 | tune.sndbuf.client <number> |
| 790 | tune.sndbuf.server <number> |
| 791 | Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to |
| 792 | the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends |
| 793 | and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets |
| 794 | the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory. |
| 795 | However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in |
| 796 | order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts |
| 797 | of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though. |
| 798 | Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due |
| 799 | to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before |
| 800 | notifying haproxy again. |
| 801 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 802 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 803 | 3.3. Debugging |
| 804 | -------------- |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 805 | |
| 806 | debug |
| 807 | Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking |
| 808 | into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It |
| 809 | should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full |
| 810 | system startup. |
| 811 | |
| 812 | quiet |
| 813 | Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command- |
| 814 | line argument "-q". |
| 815 | |
Emeric Brun | f099e79 | 2010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 816 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 817 | 3.4. Userlists |
| 818 | -------------- |
| 819 | It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to |
| 820 | http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this, |
| 821 | it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users. |
| 822 | |
| 823 | userlist <listname> |
Cyril Bonté | 78caf84 | 2010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 824 | Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 825 | used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers. |
| 826 | |
| 827 | group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)] |
Cyril Bonté | 78caf84 | 2010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 828 | Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 829 | attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names |
| 830 | proceeded by "users" keyword. |
| 831 | |
Cyril Bonté | f0c6061 | 2010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 832 | user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>] |
| 833 | [groups <group>,<group>,(...)] |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 834 | Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and |
| 835 | insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are |
Cyril Bonté | 78caf84 | 2010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 836 | evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's |
| 837 | capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 838 | based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic, |
| 839 | DES-based method of crypting passwords. |
| 840 | |
| 841 | |
| 842 | Example: |
Cyril Bonté | f0c6061 | 2010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 843 | userlist L1 |
| 844 | group G1 users tiger,scott |
| 845 | group G2 users xdb,scott |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 846 | |
Cyril Bonté | f0c6061 | 2010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 847 | user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 |
| 848 | user scott insecure-password elgato |
| 849 | user xdb insecure-password hello |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 850 | |
Cyril Bonté | f0c6061 | 2010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 851 | userlist L2 |
| 852 | group G1 |
| 853 | group G2 |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 854 | |
Cyril Bonté | f0c6061 | 2010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 855 | user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1 |
| 856 | user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2 |
| 857 | user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2 |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 858 | |
| 859 | Please note that both lists are functionally identical. |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 860 | |
Emeric Brun | f099e79 | 2010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 861 | |
| 862 | 3.5. Peers |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 863 | ---------- |
Emeric Brun | f099e79 | 2010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 864 | It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several |
| 865 | haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance |
| 866 | pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to |
| 867 | identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar |
| 868 | or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants. |
| 869 | Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last |
| 870 | known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to |
| 871 | the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new |
| 872 | process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication |
| 873 | during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large |
| 874 | tables. |
| 875 | |
| 876 | peers <peersect> |
| 877 | Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independant section, |
| 878 | which is referenced by one or more stick-tables. |
| 879 | |
| 880 | peer <peername> <ip>:<port> |
| 881 | Defines a peer inside a peers section. |
| 882 | If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced |
| 883 | using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer |
| 884 | connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to |
| 885 | to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to |
| 886 | identify and validate the remote peer on the server side. |
| 887 | |
| 888 | During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to |
| 889 | connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process). |
| 890 | |
| 891 | It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all |
| 892 | peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local |
| 893 | peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files |
| 894 | across all peers. |
| 895 | |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 896 | Example: |
Emeric Brun | f099e79 | 2010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 897 | peers mypeers |
Willy Tarreau | f7b30a9 | 2010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 898 | peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024 |
| 899 | peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024 |
| 900 | peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024 |
Emeric Brun | f099e79 | 2010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 901 | |
| 902 | backend mybackend |
| 903 | mode tcp |
| 904 | balance roundrobin |
| 905 | stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers |
| 906 | stick on src |
| 907 | |
Willy Tarreau | f7b30a9 | 2010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 908 | server srv1 192.168.0.30:80 |
| 909 | server srv2 192.168.0.31:80 |
Emeric Brun | f099e79 | 2010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 910 | |
| 911 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 912 | 4. Proxies |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 913 | ---------- |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 914 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 915 | Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections : |
| 916 | - defaults <name> |
| 917 | - frontend <name> |
| 918 | - backend <name> |
| 919 | - listen <name> |
| 920 | |
| 921 | A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following |
| 922 | its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults" |
| 923 | section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults" |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 924 | section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability. |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 925 | |
| 926 | A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client |
| 927 | connections. |
| 928 | |
| 929 | A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect |
| 930 | to forward incoming connections. |
| 931 | |
| 932 | A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend |
| 933 | parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic. |
| 934 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 935 | All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, |
| 936 | '-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are |
| 937 | case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies. |
| 938 | |
| 939 | Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the |
| 940 | logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two |
| 941 | proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names. |
| 942 | However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same |
| 943 | name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered. |
| 944 | |
| 945 | Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4, |
| 946 | and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 947 | bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 948 | protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding, |
| 949 | modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on |
| 950 | arbitrary criteria. |
| 951 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 952 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 953 | 4.1. Proxy keywords matrix |
| 954 | -------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 955 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 956 | The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a |
| 957 | limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because |
| 958 | they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally |
| 959 | limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 960 | marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 961 | option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default |
Willy Tarreau | 3842f00 | 2009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 962 | and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed |
| 963 | with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been |
| 964 | specified in a previous "defaults" section. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 965 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 966 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 967 | keyword defaults frontend listen backend |
| 968 | ------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+--------- |
| 969 | acl - X X X |
| 970 | appsession - - X X |
| 971 | backlog X X X - |
| 972 | balance X - X X |
| 973 | bind - X X - |
| 974 | bind-process X X X X |
| 975 | block - X X X |
| 976 | capture cookie - X X - |
| 977 | capture request header - X X - |
| 978 | capture response header - X X - |
| 979 | clitimeout (deprecated) X X X - |
| 980 | contimeout (deprecated) X - X X |
| 981 | cookie X - X X |
| 982 | default-server X - X X |
| 983 | default_backend X X X - |
| 984 | description - X X X |
| 985 | disabled X X X X |
| 986 | dispatch - - X X |
| 987 | enabled X X X X |
| 988 | errorfile X X X X |
| 989 | errorloc X X X X |
| 990 | errorloc302 X X X X |
| 991 | -- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend - |
| 992 | errorloc303 X X X X |
Cyril Bonté | 0d4bf01 | 2010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 993 | force-persist - X X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 994 | fullconn X - X X |
| 995 | grace X X X X |
| 996 | hash-type X - X X |
| 997 | http-check disable-on-404 X - X X |
Willy Tarreau | bd74154 | 2010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 998 | http-check expect - - X X |
Willy Tarreau | 7ab6aff | 2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 999 | http-check send-state X - X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1000 | http-request - X X X |
| 1001 | id - X X X |
Cyril Bonté | 0d4bf01 | 2010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1002 | ignore-persist - X X X |
William Lallemand | 0f99e34 | 2011-10-12 17:50:54 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1003 | log (*) X X X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1004 | maxconn X X X - |
| 1005 | mode X X X X |
| 1006 | monitor fail - X X - |
| 1007 | monitor-net X X X - |
| 1008 | monitor-uri X X X - |
| 1009 | option abortonclose (*) X - X X |
| 1010 | option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X - |
| 1011 | option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X |
| 1012 | option allbackups (*) X - X X |
| 1013 | option checkcache (*) X - X X |
| 1014 | option clitcpka (*) X X X - |
| 1015 | option contstats (*) X X X - |
| 1016 | option dontlog-normal (*) X X X - |
| 1017 | option dontlognull (*) X X X - |
| 1018 | option forceclose (*) X X X X |
| 1019 | -- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend - |
| 1020 | option forwardfor X X X X |
Willy Tarreau | 96e3121 | 2011-05-30 18:10:30 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1021 | option http-no-delay (*) X X X X |
Willy Tarreau | 8a8e1d9 | 2010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1022 | option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1023 | option http-server-close (*) X X X X |
| 1024 | option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X - |
| 1025 | option httpchk X - X X |
| 1026 | option httpclose (*) X X X X |
| 1027 | option httplog X X X X |
| 1028 | option http_proxy (*) X X X X |
| 1029 | option independant-streams (*) X X X X |
Gabor Lekeny | b4c81e4 | 2010-09-29 18:17:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1030 | option ldap-check X - X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1031 | option log-health-checks (*) X - X X |
| 1032 | option log-separate-errors (*) X X X - |
| 1033 | option logasap (*) X X X - |
| 1034 | option mysql-check X - X X |
Rauf Kuliyev | 38b4156 | 2011-01-04 15:14:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1035 | option pgsql-check X - X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1036 | option nolinger (*) X X X X |
| 1037 | option originalto X X X X |
| 1038 | option persist (*) X - X X |
| 1039 | option redispatch (*) X - X X |
Hervé COMMOWICK | ec032d6 | 2011-08-05 16:23:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1040 | option redis-check X - X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1041 | option smtpchk X - X X |
| 1042 | option socket-stats (*) X X X - |
| 1043 | option splice-auto (*) X X X X |
| 1044 | option splice-request (*) X X X X |
| 1045 | option splice-response (*) X X X X |
| 1046 | option srvtcpka (*) X - X X |
| 1047 | option ssl-hello-chk X - X X |
| 1048 | -- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend - |
| 1049 | option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X - |
| 1050 | option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X |
| 1051 | option tcpka X X X X |
| 1052 | option tcplog X X X X |
| 1053 | option transparent (*) X - X X |
| 1054 | persist rdp-cookie X - X X |
| 1055 | rate-limit sessions X X X - |
| 1056 | redirect - X X X |
| 1057 | redisp (deprecated) X - X X |
| 1058 | redispatch (deprecated) X - X X |
| 1059 | reqadd - X X X |
| 1060 | reqallow - X X X |
| 1061 | reqdel - X X X |
| 1062 | reqdeny - X X X |
| 1063 | reqiallow - X X X |
| 1064 | reqidel - X X X |
| 1065 | reqideny - X X X |
| 1066 | reqipass - X X X |
| 1067 | reqirep - X X X |
| 1068 | reqisetbe - X X X |
| 1069 | reqitarpit - X X X |
| 1070 | reqpass - X X X |
| 1071 | reqrep - X X X |
| 1072 | -- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend - |
| 1073 | reqsetbe - X X X |
| 1074 | reqtarpit - X X X |
| 1075 | retries X - X X |
| 1076 | rspadd - X X X |
| 1077 | rspdel - X X X |
| 1078 | rspdeny - X X X |
| 1079 | rspidel - X X X |
| 1080 | rspideny - X X X |
| 1081 | rspirep - X X X |
| 1082 | rsprep - X X X |
| 1083 | server - - X X |
| 1084 | source X - X X |
| 1085 | srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X |
Cyril Bonté | 66c327d | 2010-10-12 00:14:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1086 | stats admin - - X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1087 | stats auth X - X X |
| 1088 | stats enable X - X X |
| 1089 | stats hide-version X - X X |
Cyril Bonté | 2be1b3f | 2010-09-30 23:46:30 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1090 | stats http-request - - X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1091 | stats realm X - X X |
| 1092 | stats refresh X - X X |
| 1093 | stats scope X - X X |
| 1094 | stats show-desc X - X X |
| 1095 | stats show-legends X - X X |
| 1096 | stats show-node X - X X |
| 1097 | stats uri X - X X |
| 1098 | -- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend - |
| 1099 | stick match - - X X |
| 1100 | stick on - - X X |
| 1101 | stick store-request - - X X |
Willy Tarreau | d8dc99f | 2011-07-01 11:33:25 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1102 | stick store-response - - X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1103 | stick-table - - X X |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1104 | tcp-request connection - X X - |
| 1105 | tcp-request content - X X X |
Willy Tarreau | a56235c | 2010-09-14 11:31:36 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1106 | tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X |
Emeric Brun | 0a3b67f | 2010-09-24 15:34:53 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1107 | tcp-response content - - X X |
| 1108 | tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1109 | timeout check X - X X |
| 1110 | timeout client X X X - |
| 1111 | timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X - |
| 1112 | timeout connect X - X X |
| 1113 | timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X |
| 1114 | timeout http-keep-alive X X X X |
| 1115 | timeout http-request X X X X |
| 1116 | timeout queue X - X X |
| 1117 | timeout server X - X X |
| 1118 | timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X |
| 1119 | timeout tarpit X X X X |
Willy Tarreau | ce887fd | 2012-05-12 12:50:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1120 | timeout tunnel X - X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1121 | transparent (deprecated) X - X X |
William Lallemand | a73203e | 2012-03-12 12:48:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1122 | unique-id-format X X X - |
| 1123 | unique-id-header X X X - |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1124 | use_backend - X X - |
Willy Tarreau | 4a5cade | 2012-04-05 21:09:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1125 | use-server - - X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1126 | ------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+--------- |
| 1127 | keyword defaults frontend listen backend |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1128 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1129 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1130 | 4.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference |
| 1131 | --------------------------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1132 | |
| 1133 | This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage. |
| 1134 | |
| 1135 | |
| 1136 | acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ... |
| 1137 | Declare or complete an access list. |
| 1138 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1139 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 1140 | Example: |
| 1141 | acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3 |
| 1142 | acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023 |
| 1143 | acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost |
| 1144 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1145 | See section 7 about ACL usage. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1146 | |
| 1147 | |
Cyril Bonté | b21570a | 2009-11-29 20:04:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1148 | appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime> |
| 1149 | [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>] |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1150 | Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie. |
| 1151 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1152 | no | no | yes | yes |
| 1153 | Arguments : |
| 1154 | <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which |
| 1155 | HAProxy will have to learn for each new session. |
| 1156 | |
Cyril Bonté | b21570a | 2009-11-29 20:04:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1157 | <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1158 | checked in each cookie value. |
| 1159 | |
| 1160 | <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from |
| 1161 | memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in |
| 1162 | milliseconds. |
| 1163 | |
Cyril Bonté | bf47aeb | 2009-10-15 00:15:40 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1164 | request-learn |
| 1165 | If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn |
| 1166 | the cookie found in the request in case the server does not |
| 1167 | specify any in response. This is typically what happens with |
| 1168 | PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before |
| 1169 | the application's session and the correct server is selected. |
| 1170 | It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability. |
| 1171 | |
Cyril Bonté | b21570a | 2009-11-29 20:04:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1172 | prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie |
| 1173 | prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the |
| 1174 | data following this prefix. |
| 1175 | |
| 1176 | Example : |
| 1177 | appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix |
| 1178 | |
| 1179 | This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX, |
| 1180 | the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX. |
| 1181 | |
| 1182 | mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode. |
| 1183 | 2 modes are currently supported : |
| 1184 | - path-parameters : |
| 1185 | The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters |
| 1186 | part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is |
| 1187 | convenient for JSESSIONID for example. |
| 1188 | This is the default mode if the option is not set. |
| 1189 | - query-string : |
| 1190 | In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the |
| 1191 | query string. |
| 1192 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1193 | When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when |
| 1194 | the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and |
| 1195 | associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from |
| 1196 | the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this |
Cyril Bonté | b21570a | 2009-11-29 20:04:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1197 | cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on |
| 1198 | the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the |
| 1199 | server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1200 | applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been |
| 1201 | unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>. |
| 1202 | |
| 1203 | The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend. |
| 1204 | |
Cyril Bonté | 02ff8ef | 2010-12-14 22:48:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1205 | Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1) |
| 1206 | unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the |
| 1207 | processes, which can result in random behaviours. |
| 1208 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1209 | Example : |
| 1210 | appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h |
| 1211 | |
Cyril Bonté | 02ff8ef | 2010-12-14 22:48:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1212 | See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table", |
| 1213 | "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process". |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1214 | |
| 1215 | |
Willy Tarreau | c73ce2b | 2008-01-06 10:55:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1216 | backlog <conns> |
| 1217 | Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size |
| 1218 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1219 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 1220 | Arguments : |
| 1221 | <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating |
| 1222 | system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1223 | connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both. |
Willy Tarreau | c73ce2b | 2008-01-06 10:55:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1224 | |
| 1225 | In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase |
| 1226 | the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just |
| 1227 | tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and |
| 1228 | sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of |
| 1229 | the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value |
| 1230 | to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can |
| 1231 | sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this |
| 1232 | backlog parameter. |
| 1233 | |
| 1234 | On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is |
| 1235 | used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of |
| 1236 | two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768). |
| 1237 | |
| 1238 | See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide. |
| 1239 | |
| 1240 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1241 | balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ] |
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com | 1c2ab96 | 2008-04-14 20:47:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1242 | balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]] |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1243 | Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend. |
| 1244 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1245 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 1246 | Arguments : |
| 1247 | <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load |
| 1248 | balancing. This only applies when no persistence information |
| 1249 | is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another |
| 1250 | server. <algorithm> may be one of the following : |
| 1251 | |
| 1252 | roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights. |
| 1253 | This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's |
| 1254 | processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm |
| 1255 | is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted |
Willy Tarreau | 9757a38 | 2009-10-03 12:56:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1256 | on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by |
| 1257 | design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some |
| 1258 | large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down |
| 1259 | for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds |
| 1260 | requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start |
| 1261 | receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is |
| 1262 | indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe |
| 1263 | it, so that you don't worry. |
| 1264 | |
| 1265 | static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights. |
| 1266 | This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is |
| 1267 | static, which means that changing a server's weight on the |
| 1268 | fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design |
| 1269 | limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes |
| 1270 | up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once |
| 1271 | the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to |
| 1272 | run (around -1%). |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1273 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2d2a7f8 | 2008-03-17 12:07:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1274 | leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the |
| 1275 | connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers |
| 1276 | of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use |
| 1277 | of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are |
| 1278 | expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well |
| 1279 | suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This |
| 1280 | algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be |
| 1281 | adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. |
| 1282 | |
Willy Tarreau | f09c660 | 2012-02-13 17:12:08 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1283 | first The first server with available connection slots receives the |
| 1284 | connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric |
| 1285 | identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which |
| 1286 | defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server |
Willy Tarreau | 64559c5 | 2012-04-07 09:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1287 | reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does |
Willy Tarreau | f09c660 | 2012-02-13 17:12:08 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1288 | not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn. |
| 1289 | The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest |
| 1290 | number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off |
| 1291 | during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server |
| 1292 | weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP |
Willy Tarreau | 64559c5 | 2012-04-07 09:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1293 | or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In |
| 1294 | order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended |
| 1295 | that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn |
| 1296 | them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to |
| 1297 | turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively, |
| 1298 | using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load. |
Willy Tarreau | f09c660 | 2012-02-13 17:12:08 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1299 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1300 | source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total |
| 1301 | weight of the running servers to designate which server will |
| 1302 | receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP |
| 1303 | address will always reach the same server as long as no |
| 1304 | server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the |
| 1305 | number of running servers changing, many clients will be |
| 1306 | directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally |
| 1307 | used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1308 | be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1309 | to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is |
Willy Tarreau | 6b2e11b | 2009-10-01 07:52:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1310 | static by default, which means that changing a server's |
| 1311 | weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be |
| 1312 | changed using "hash-type". |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1313 | |
Oskar Stolc | 8dc4184 | 2012-05-19 10:19:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1314 | uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before |
| 1315 | the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter |
| 1316 | is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of |
| 1317 | the running servers. The result designates which server will |
| 1318 | receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will |
| 1319 | always be directed to the same server as long as no server |
| 1320 | goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and |
| 1321 | anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate. |
| 1322 | Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend. |
| 1323 | This algorithm is static by default, which means that |
| 1324 | changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect, |
| 1325 | but this can be changed using "hash-type". |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1326 | |
Oskar Stolc | 8dc4184 | 2012-05-19 10:19:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1327 | This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and |
Marek Majkowski | 9c30fc1 | 2008-04-27 23:25:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1328 | "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These |
| 1329 | options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers |
| 1330 | based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter |
| 1331 | indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many |
| 1332 | characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash. |
| 1333 | Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most |
| 1334 | URIs start with a leading "/". |
| 1335 | |
| 1336 | The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth |
| 1337 | to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each |
| 1338 | slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the |
| 1339 | evaluation stops when either is reached. |
| 1340 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1341 | url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in |
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com | 1c2ab96 | 2008-04-14 20:47:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1342 | the query string of each HTTP GET request. |
| 1343 | |
| 1344 | If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1345 | request entity will be searched for the parameter argument, |
| 1346 | when it is not found in a query string after a question mark |
| 1347 | ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to |
| 1348 | wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the |
| 1349 | entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each |
| 1350 | request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB |
| 1351 | parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The |
| 1352 | default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the |
| 1353 | required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this |
| 1354 | is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first |
| 1355 | chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does |
| 1356 | not need to wait for more data than the client promised to |
| 1357 | send. When Content-Length is present and larger than |
| 1358 | <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is |
| 1359 | assumed that this will be enough data to search for the |
| 1360 | presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that |
| 1361 | Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is |
| 1362 | scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may |
| 1363 | be randomly balanced if at all. |
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com | 1c2ab96 | 2008-04-14 20:47:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1364 | |
| 1365 | If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and |
| 1366 | a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total |
| 1367 | weight of the running servers. The result designates which |
| 1368 | server will receive the request. |
| 1369 | |
| 1370 | This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure |
| 1371 | that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as |
| 1372 | long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if |
| 1373 | the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is |
| 1374 | applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP |
Willy Tarreau | 6b2e11b | 2009-10-01 07:52:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1375 | backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means |
| 1376 | that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no |
| 1377 | effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type". |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1378 | |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1379 | hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP |
| 1380 | request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function, |
| 1381 | the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the |
| 1382 | header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the |
| 1383 | roundrobin algorithm is applied instead. |
Benoit | affb481 | 2009-03-25 13:02:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1384 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1385 | An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for |
Benoit | affb481 | 2009-03-25 13:02:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1386 | reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some |
| 1387 | specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host |
| 1388 | value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered. |
| 1389 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6b2e11b | 2009-10-01 07:52:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1390 | This algorithm is static by default, which means that |
| 1391 | changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect, |
| 1392 | but this can be changed using "hash-type". |
| 1393 | |
Emeric Brun | 736aa23 | 2009-06-30 17:56:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1394 | rdp-cookie |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1395 | rdp-cookie(<name>) |
Emeric Brun | 736aa23 | 2009-06-30 17:56:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1396 | The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be |
| 1397 | looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as |
| 1398 | with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name |
| 1399 | is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded |
| 1400 | persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the |
| 1401 | same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1402 | cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is |
Emeric Brun | 736aa23 | 2009-06-30 17:56:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1403 | used instead. |
| 1404 | |
| 1405 | Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an |
| 1406 | RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this |
| 1407 | you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with |
| 1408 | a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL. |
| 1409 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6b2e11b | 2009-10-01 07:52:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1410 | This algorithm is static by default, which means that |
| 1411 | changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect, |
| 1412 | but this can be changed using "hash-type". |
| 1413 | |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1414 | See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function. |
Simon Horman | ab814e0 | 2011-06-24 14:50:20 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 1415 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1416 | <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some |
Marek Majkowski | 9c30fc1 | 2008-04-27 23:25:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1417 | algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an |
| 1418 | optional argument. |
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com | 1c2ab96 | 2008-04-14 20:47:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1419 | |
Marek Majkowski | 9c30fc1 | 2008-04-27 23:25:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1420 | balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>] |
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com | 1c2ab96 | 2008-04-14 20:47:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1421 | balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]] |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1422 | |
Willy Tarreau | 3cd9af2 | 2009-03-15 14:06:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1423 | The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other |
| 1424 | algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once |
| 1425 | for each backend. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1426 | |
| 1427 | Examples : |
| 1428 | balance roundrobin |
| 1429 | balance url_param userid |
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com | 1c2ab96 | 2008-04-14 20:47:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1430 | balance url_param session_id check_post 64 |
Benoit | affb481 | 2009-03-25 13:02:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1431 | balance hdr(User-Agent) |
| 1432 | balance hdr(host) |
| 1433 | balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only |
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com | 1c2ab96 | 2008-04-14 20:47:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1434 | |
| 1435 | Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post" |
| 1436 | extension with "url_param" must be considered : |
| 1437 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1438 | - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way |
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com | 1c2ab96 | 2008-04-14 20:47:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1439 | to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which |
| 1440 | may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to |
| 1441 | restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in |
| 1442 | the body. (see acl reqideny http_end) |
| 1443 | |
| 1444 | - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not |
| 1445 | make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and |
| 1446 | defaults to 16 kB. |
| 1447 | |
| 1448 | - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably |
| 1449 | fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin. |
| 1450 | |
| 1451 | - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to |
| 1452 | Round Robin. |
| 1453 | |
| 1454 | - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk. |
| 1455 | If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the |
| 1456 | selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little |
| 1457 | actually appeared in the first chunk). |
| 1458 | |
| 1459 | - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response. |
| 1460 | |
| 1461 | - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1462 | contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear |
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com | 1c2ab96 | 2008-04-14 20:47:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1463 | white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what |
| 1464 | might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML |
| 1465 | type message bodies. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1466 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6b2e11b | 2009-10-01 07:52:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1467 | See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and |
| 1468 | "http_proxy". |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1469 | |
| 1470 | |
Willy Tarreau | c5011ca | 2010-03-22 11:53:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1471 | bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] |
| 1472 | bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface> |
| 1473 | bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg> |
| 1474 | bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent |
| 1475 | bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id> |
| 1476 | bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name> |
| 1477 | bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept |
Willy Tarreau | 71c814e | 2010-10-29 21:56:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1478 | bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] accept-proxy |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1479 | bind /<path> [, ...] |
| 1480 | bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode> |
| 1481 | bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ] |
| 1482 | bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ] |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1483 | Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend. |
| 1484 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1485 | no | yes | yes | no |
| 1486 | Arguments : |
Willy Tarreau | b1e52e8 | 2008-01-13 14:49:51 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1487 | <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 |
| 1488 | address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will |
| 1489 | listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be |
| 1490 | listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's |
David du Colombier | 9c938da | 2011-03-17 10:40:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1491 | special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'. |
Willy Tarreau | b1e52e8 | 2008-01-13 14:49:51 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1492 | |
Willy Tarreau | c5011ca | 2010-03-22 11:53:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1493 | <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the |
| 1494 | proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1495 | above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in |
| 1496 | the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number |
| 1497 | after the last colon (':'). A range can either be : |
Willy Tarreau | c5011ca | 2010-03-22 11:53:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1498 | - a numerical port (ex: '80') |
| 1499 | - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower |
| 1500 | and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in |
| 1501 | the range. |
| 1502 | |
| 1503 | Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because |
| 1504 | every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file |
| 1505 | descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors |
| 1506 | with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each |
| 1507 | <address:port> couple must be used only once among all |
| 1508 | instances running on a same system. Please note that binding |
| 1509 | to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular |
| 1510 | privileges to start the program, which are independant of |
| 1511 | the 'uid' parameter. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1512 | |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1513 | <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is |
| 1514 | alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then |
| 1515 | receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place. |
| 1516 | The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute. |
| 1517 | It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in |
| 1518 | the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix |
| 1519 | followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits |
| 1520 | for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters. |
| 1521 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5e6e204 | 2009-02-04 17:19:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1522 | <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently |
| 1523 | only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical |
| 1524 | interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all |
| 1525 | addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the |
| 1526 | incoming packet physically come through the designated |
| 1527 | interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to |
| 1528 | the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. |
| 1529 | Note that binding to a physical interface requires root |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1530 | privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP |
| 1531 | sockets. |
Willy Tarreau | 5e6e204 | 2009-02-04 17:19:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1532 | |
Willy Tarreau | be1b918 | 2009-06-14 18:48:19 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1533 | <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be |
| 1534 | advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force |
| 1535 | a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for |
| 1536 | connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a |
| 1537 | kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but |
| 1538 | was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not |
Willy Tarreau | 48a7e72 | 2010-12-24 15:26:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1539 | work on other operating systems. It may also not change the |
| 1540 | advertised value but change the effective size of outgoing |
| 1541 | segments. The commonly advertised value on Ethernet networks |
| 1542 | is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is positive, |
| 1543 | it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it |
| 1544 | will indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's |
| 1545 | advertised MSS for outgoing segments. This parameter is only |
| 1546 | compatible with TCP sockets. |
Willy Tarreau | be1b918 | 2009-06-14 18:48:19 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1547 | |
Willy Tarreau | 53fb4ae | 2009-10-04 23:04:08 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1548 | <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and |
| 1549 | unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be |
| 1550 | assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a |
| 1551 | single socket. |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | aeebf9b | 2009-10-04 15:43:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1552 | |
| 1553 | <name> is an optional name provided for stats |
| 1554 | |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1555 | <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the |
| 1556 | UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global |
| 1557 | section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms |
| 1558 | simply ignore this. |
| 1559 | |
| 1560 | <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX |
| 1561 | socket. It can also be set by default in the global |
| 1562 | section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms |
| 1563 | simply ignore this. |
| 1564 | |
| 1565 | <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX |
| 1566 | socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's |
| 1567 | "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore |
| 1568 | this. |
| 1569 | |
| 1570 | <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX |
| 1571 | socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's |
| 1572 | "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore |
| 1573 | this. |
| 1574 | |
| 1575 | <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX |
| 1576 | socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's |
| 1577 | "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore |
| 1578 | this. |
| 1579 | |
Willy Tarreau | b1e52e8 | 2008-01-13 14:49:51 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1580 | transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain |
| 1581 | Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound |
| 1582 | even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1583 | targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if |
Willy Tarreau | b1e52e8 | 2008-01-13 14:49:51 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1584 | the address was locally configured. This normally requires |
| 1585 | that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with |
| 1586 | the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for |
| 1587 | the specified port. This keyword is available only when |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1588 | HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is |
| 1589 | only compatible with TCP sockets. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1590 | |
Willy Tarreau | 59f8920 | 2010-10-02 11:54:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1591 | defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain |
Willy Tarreau | cb6cd43 | 2009-10-13 07:34:14 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1592 | Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be |
| 1593 | accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the |
| 1594 | first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for |
| 1595 | which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly |
| 1596 | improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is |
| 1597 | already available when the connection is accepted. On the |
| 1598 | other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which |
| 1599 | don't talk. It is important to note that this option is |
| 1600 | broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is |
| 1601 | never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues |
| 1602 | with front firewalls which would see an established |
| 1603 | connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. |
| 1604 | |
Willy Tarreau | 71c814e | 2010-10-29 21:56:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1605 | accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY |
| 1606 | protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The |
| 1607 | PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the |
| 1608 | incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, |
| 1609 | with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules |
| 1610 | which will only see the real connection address. Logs will |
| 1611 | reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is |
| 1612 | violated, in which case the real address will still be used. |
| 1613 | This keyword combined with support from external components |
| 1614 | can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the |
| 1615 | X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and |
| 1616 | not even always usable. |
| 1617 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1618 | It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by |
| 1619 | commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no |
| 1620 | fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in |
| 1621 | a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements |
| 1622 | in a frontend. |
| 1623 | |
| 1624 | Example : |
| 1625 | listen http_proxy |
| 1626 | bind :80,:443 |
| 1627 | bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443 |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1628 | bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1629 | |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1630 | See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol |
Willy Tarreau | 71c814e | 2010-10-29 21:56:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1631 | documentation. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1632 | |
| 1633 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0b9c02c | 2009-02-04 22:05:05 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1634 | bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ... |
| 1635 | Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers. |
| 1636 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1637 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 1638 | Arguments : |
| 1639 | all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It |
| 1640 | may be used to override a default value. |
| 1641 | |
| 1642 | odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This |
| 1643 | option may be combined with other numbers. |
| 1644 | |
| 1645 | even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This |
| 1646 | option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it |
| 1647 | with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be |
| 1648 | missing from all processes. |
| 1649 | |
| 1650 | number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between |
| 1651 | 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process |
| 1652 | number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise |
| 1653 | some instances might be missing from all processes. |
| 1654 | |
| 1655 | This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This |
| 1656 | is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same |
| 1657 | ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set |
| 1658 | 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd' |
| 1659 | and 'even' instances. |
| 1660 | |
| 1661 | At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using |
| 1662 | this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please |
| 1663 | note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first |
| 1664 | 32. |
| 1665 | |
| 1666 | If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the |
| 1667 | backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes. |
| 1668 | |
| 1669 | Example : |
| 1670 | listen app_ip1 |
| 1671 | bind 10.0.0.1:80 |
Willy Tarreau | bfcd311 | 2010-10-23 11:22:08 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1672 | bind-process odd |
Willy Tarreau | 0b9c02c | 2009-02-04 22:05:05 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1673 | |
| 1674 | listen app_ip2 |
| 1675 | bind 10.0.0.2:80 |
Willy Tarreau | bfcd311 | 2010-10-23 11:22:08 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1676 | bind-process even |
Willy Tarreau | 0b9c02c | 2009-02-04 22:05:05 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1677 | |
| 1678 | listen management |
| 1679 | bind 10.0.0.3:80 |
Willy Tarreau | bfcd311 | 2010-10-23 11:22:08 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1680 | bind-process 1 2 3 4 |
Willy Tarreau | 0b9c02c | 2009-02-04 22:05:05 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1681 | |
| 1682 | See also : "nbproc" in global section. |
| 1683 | |
| 1684 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1685 | block { if | unless } <condition> |
| 1686 | Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched |
| 1687 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1688 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 1689 | |
| 1690 | The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing |
| 1691 | if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1692 | is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is |
Willy Tarreau | 3c92c5f | 2011-08-28 09:45:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1693 | typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1694 | conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of |
| 1695 | "block" statements per instance. |
| 1696 | |
| 1697 | Example: |
| 1698 | acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3 |
| 1699 | acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023 |
| 1700 | acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost |
| 1701 | block if invalid_src || local_dst |
| 1702 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1703 | See section 7 about ACL usage. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1704 | |
| 1705 | |
| 1706 | capture cookie <name> len <length> |
| 1707 | Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response. |
| 1708 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1709 | no | yes | yes | no |
| 1710 | Arguments : |
| 1711 | <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order |
| 1712 | to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal |
| 1713 | sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is |
| 1714 | useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name |
| 1715 | and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX). |
| 1716 | |
| 1717 | <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which |
| 1718 | include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the |
| 1719 | standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the |
| 1720 | right if it exceeds <length>. |
| 1721 | |
| 1722 | Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the |
| 1723 | "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to |
| 1724 | check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between |
| 1725 | users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page. |
| 1726 | |
| 1727 | When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column |
| 1728 | will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the |
| 1729 | server, a "-" is reported in the response column. |
| 1730 | |
| 1731 | The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that |
| 1732 | the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the |
| 1733 | backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one |
| 1734 | "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1735 | configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1736 | specify a capture in a "defaults" section. |
| 1737 | |
| 1738 | Example: |
| 1739 | capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32 |
| 1740 | |
| 1741 | See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1742 | section 8 about logging. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1743 | |
| 1744 | |
| 1745 | capture request header <name> len <length> |
| 1746 | Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header. |
| 1747 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1748 | no | yes | yes | no |
| 1749 | Arguments : |
| 1750 | <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1751 | case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1752 | appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in |
| 1753 | upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the |
| 1754 | value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected. |
| 1755 | |
| 1756 | <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and |
| 1757 | report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if |
| 1758 | it exceeds <length>. |
| 1759 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1760 | Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1761 | value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers |
| 1762 | are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1763 | in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent |
| 1764 | headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request |
| 1765 | header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the |
| 1766 | "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1767 | differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1768 | environments to find where the request came from. |
| 1769 | |
| 1770 | Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be |
| 1771 | logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what |
| 1772 | you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the |
| 1773 | braces. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1774 | |
| 1775 | There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture |
| 1776 | is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a |
| 1777 | same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not |
| 1778 | possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section. |
| 1779 | |
| 1780 | Example: |
| 1781 | capture request header Host len 15 |
| 1782 | capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15 |
| 1783 | capture request header Referrer len 15 |
| 1784 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1785 | See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8 |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1786 | about logging. |
| 1787 | |
| 1788 | |
| 1789 | capture response header <name> len <length> |
| 1790 | Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header. |
| 1791 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1792 | no | yes | yes | no |
| 1793 | Arguments : |
| 1794 | <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1795 | case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1796 | appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in |
| 1797 | upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the |
| 1798 | value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected. |
| 1799 | |
| 1800 | <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and |
| 1801 | report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if |
| 1802 | it exceeds <length>. |
| 1803 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1804 | Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1805 | result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured |
| 1806 | request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by |
| 1807 | a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1808 | the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty |
| 1809 | string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length" |
| 1810 | header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the |
| 1811 | "Location" header to track redirections. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1812 | |
| 1813 | There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each |
| 1814 | capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent |
| 1815 | for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It |
| 1816 | is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section. |
| 1817 | |
| 1818 | Example: |
| 1819 | capture response header Content-length len 9 |
| 1820 | capture response header Location len 15 |
| 1821 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1822 | See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8 |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1823 | about logging. |
| 1824 | |
| 1825 | |
Cyril Bonté | f0c6061 | 2010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1826 | clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated) |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1827 | Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side. |
| 1828 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1829 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 1830 | Arguments : |
| 1831 | <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but |
| 1832 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 1833 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 1834 | |
| 1835 | The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or |
| 1836 | send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider |
| 1837 | during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the |
| 1838 | response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified |
| 1839 | in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is |
| 1840 | suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode |
| 1841 | (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the |
| 1842 | client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1843 | situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1844 | losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds |
| 1845 | (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). |
| 1846 | |
| 1847 | This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in |
| 1848 | "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to |
| 1849 | forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which |
| 1850 | is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning |
| 1851 | during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in |
| 1852 | the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either. |
| 1853 | |
| 1854 | This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated. |
| 1855 | Please use "timeout client" instead. |
| 1856 | |
Willy Tarreau | 036fae0 | 2008-01-06 13:24:40 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1857 | See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and |
| 1858 | "srvtimeout". |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1859 | |
| 1860 | |
Cyril Bonté | f0c6061 | 2010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1861 | contimeout <timeout> (deprecated) |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1862 | Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed. |
| 1863 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1864 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 1865 | Arguments : |
| 1866 | <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but |
| 1867 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 1868 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 1869 | |
| 1870 | If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1871 | immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1872 | cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1873 | slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the |
| 1874 | connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one |
| 1875 | has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the |
| 1876 | tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend. |
| 1877 | |
| 1878 | This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in |
| 1879 | "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to |
| 1880 | forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which |
| 1881 | is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning |
| 1882 | during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in |
| 1883 | the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either. |
| 1884 | |
| 1885 | This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently |
| 1886 | deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit" |
| 1887 | instead. |
| 1888 | |
| 1889 | See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit", |
| 1890 | "timeout server", "contimeout". |
| 1891 | |
| 1892 | |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1893 | cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ] |
Willy Tarreau | ba4c5be | 2010-10-23 12:46:42 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1894 | [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ domain <domain> ]* |
Willy Tarreau | 996a92c | 2010-10-13 19:30:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1895 | [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ] |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1896 | Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend. |
| 1897 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1898 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 1899 | Arguments : |
| 1900 | <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or |
| 1901 | inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to |
| 1902 | the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is |
| 1903 | brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests. |
| 1904 | Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not |
| 1905 | conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same |
| 1906 | backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg: |
| 1907 | HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names |
| 1908 | between all backends if persistence between them is not desired. |
| 1909 | |
| 1910 | rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the |
| 1911 | server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the |
| 1912 | server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management |
| 1913 | of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control" |
| 1914 | headers is left to the application. The application can then |
| 1915 | decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence |
| 1916 | cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only |
| 1917 | works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is |
| 1918 | very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this |
| 1919 | mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with |
| 1920 | "insert" and "prefix". |
| 1921 | |
| 1922 | insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to |
Willy Tarreau | a79094d | 2010-08-31 22:54:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1923 | be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not |
Willy Tarreau | ba4c5be | 2010-10-23 12:46:42 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1924 | |
Willy Tarreau | a79094d | 2010-08-31 22:54:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1925 | already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this |
Willy Tarreau | ba4c5be | 2010-10-23 12:46:42 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1926 | server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server |
| 1927 | emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before |
| 1928 | processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade |
| 1929 | existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie |
| 1930 | will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the |
| 1931 | client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added, |
| 1932 | the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to |
| 1933 | caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or |
| 1934 | "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not |
| 1935 | compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix". |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1936 | |
| 1937 | prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated |
| 1938 | cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed. |
| 1939 | This may be needed in some specific environments where the client |
| 1940 | does not support more than one single cookie and the application |
| 1941 | already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie |
| 1942 | named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier |
| 1943 | and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client |
| 1944 | requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted. |
| 1945 | Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified, |
| 1946 | this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is |
Willy Tarreau | 37229df | 2011-10-17 12:24:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1947 | not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly |
| 1948 | recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server |
| 1949 | cookie updates would not be sent to clients. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1950 | |
Willy Tarreau | a79094d | 2010-08-31 22:54:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1951 | indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a |
| 1952 | client which already has a valid one for the server which has |
| 1953 | processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself, |
Willy Tarreau | ba4c5be | 2010-10-23 12:46:42 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1954 | it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In |
| 1955 | "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the |
| 1956 | requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence |
| 1957 | mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view. |
Willy Tarreau | 37229df | 2011-10-17 12:24:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1958 | Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with |
| 1959 | "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to |
| 1960 | clients. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1961 | |
| 1962 | nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode |
| 1963 | when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it |
| 1964 | ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if |
| 1965 | a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all |
| 1966 | persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for |
| 1967 | instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an |
| 1968 | outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie, |
| 1969 | leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others. |
| 1970 | See also the "insert" and "postonly" options. |
| 1971 | |
| 1972 | postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed |
| 1973 | on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the |
| 1974 | "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so |
| 1975 | this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached. |
| 1976 | Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the |
| 1977 | first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very |
| 1978 | efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a |
| 1979 | persistence cookie in the cache. |
| 1980 | See also the "insert" and "nocache" options. |
| 1981 | |
Willy Tarreau | ba4c5be | 2010-10-23 12:46:42 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1982 | preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It |
| 1983 | allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this |
| 1984 | case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it |
| 1985 | untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a |
| 1986 | logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to |
| 1987 | emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in |
| 1988 | the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404" |
| 1989 | check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful |
| 1990 | shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after |
| 1991 | they logout. |
| 1992 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | efe3b6f | 2008-05-23 23:49:32 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1993 | domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1994 | inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain |
Willy Tarreau | 68a897b | 2009-12-03 23:28:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1995 | name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to |
| 1996 | use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to |
| 1997 | specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple |
| 1998 | times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of |
| 1999 | domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending |
| 2000 | 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected. |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | efe3b6f | 2008-05-23 23:49:32 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2001 | |
Willy Tarreau | 996a92c | 2010-10-13 19:30:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2002 | maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle |
| 2003 | time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is |
| 2004 | sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too. |
| 2005 | Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older |
| 2006 | than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will |
| 2007 | be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the |
| 2008 | response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to |
| 2009 | prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for |
| 2010 | too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When |
| 2011 | this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always |
| 2012 | accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the |
| 2013 | ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a |
| 2014 | date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so |
| 2015 | lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off |
| 2016 | the site. |
| 2017 | |
| 2018 | maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life |
| 2019 | time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert |
| 2020 | mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date |
| 2021 | this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations |
| 2022 | of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by |
| 2023 | the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in |
| 2024 | the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set. |
| 2025 | Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are |
| 2026 | ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking |
| 2027 | kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is |
| 2028 | not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and |
| 2029 | maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to |
| 2030 | prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for |
| 2031 | too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This |
| 2032 | is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a |
| 2033 | redispatch after some absolute delay. |
| 2034 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2035 | There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be |
| 2036 | declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value |
| 2037 | indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie |
| 2038 | is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set. |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2039 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2040 | Examples : |
| 2041 | cookie JSESSIONID prefix |
| 2042 | cookie SRV insert indirect nocache |
| 2043 | cookie SRV insert postonly indirect |
Willy Tarreau | 996a92c | 2010-10-13 19:30:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2044 | cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2045 | |
Cyril Bonté | a8e7bbc | 2010-04-25 22:29:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2046 | See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" |
Cyril Bonté | 0d4bf01 | 2010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2047 | and "ignore-persist". |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2048 | |
Willy Tarreau | 983e01e | 2010-01-11 18:42:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2049 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c6df066 | 2010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2050 | default-server [param*] |
| 2051 | Change default options for a server in a backend |
| 2052 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2053 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 2054 | Arguments: |
Willy Tarreau | 983e01e | 2010-01-11 18:42:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2055 | <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server" |
| 2056 | keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete |
| 2057 | section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more |
| 2058 | details. |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c6df066 | 2010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2059 | |
Willy Tarreau | 983e01e | 2010-01-11 18:42:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2060 | Example : |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c6df066 | 2010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2061 | default-server inter 1000 weight 13 |
| 2062 | |
| 2063 | See also: "server" and section 5 about server options |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2064 | |
Willy Tarreau | 983e01e | 2010-01-11 18:42:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2065 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2066 | default_backend <backend> |
| 2067 | Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched. |
| 2068 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2069 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 2070 | Arguments : |
| 2071 | <backend> is the name of the backend to use. |
| 2072 | |
| 2073 | When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the |
| 2074 | "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be |
| 2075 | used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which |
| 2076 | will catch all undetermined requests. |
| 2077 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2078 | Example : |
| 2079 | |
| 2080 | use_backend dynamic if url_dyn |
| 2081 | use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img |
| 2082 | default_backend dynamic |
| 2083 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2084 | See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe" |
| 2085 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2086 | |
| 2087 | disabled |
| 2088 | Disable a proxy, frontend or backend. |
| 2089 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2090 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 2091 | Arguments : none |
| 2092 | |
| 2093 | The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to |
| 2094 | liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance |
| 2095 | will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be |
| 2096 | created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It |
| 2097 | will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It |
| 2098 | is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled" |
| 2099 | keyword in a "defaults" section. |
| 2100 | |
| 2101 | See also : "enabled" |
| 2102 | |
| 2103 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5ce9457 | 2010-06-07 14:35:41 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2104 | dispatch <address>:<port> |
| 2105 | Set a default server address |
| 2106 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2107 | no | no | yes | yes |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2108 | Arguments : |
Willy Tarreau | 5ce9457 | 2010-06-07 14:35:41 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2109 | |
| 2110 | <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a |
| 2111 | resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved |
| 2112 | during start-up. |
| 2113 | |
| 2114 | <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent |
| 2115 | to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is |
| 2116 | possible with normal servers. |
| 2117 | |
Willy Tarreau | 787aed5 | 2011-04-15 06:45:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2118 | The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other |
Willy Tarreau | 5ce9457 | 2010-06-07 14:35:41 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2119 | server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non |
| 2120 | persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple |
| 2121 | syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to |
| 2122 | use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead. |
| 2123 | |
| 2124 | See also : "server" |
| 2125 | |
| 2126 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2127 | enabled |
| 2128 | Enable a proxy, frontend or backend. |
| 2129 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2130 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 2131 | Arguments : none |
| 2132 | |
| 2133 | The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the |
| 2134 | defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used. |
| 2135 | |
| 2136 | See also : "disabled" |
| 2137 | |
| 2138 | |
| 2139 | errorfile <code> <file> |
| 2140 | Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy |
| 2141 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2142 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 2143 | Arguments : |
| 2144 | <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of |
Willy Tarreau | ae94d4d | 2011-05-11 16:28:49 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2145 | generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2146 | |
| 2147 | <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2148 | recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2149 | the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML |
Willy Tarreau | 59140a2 | 2009-02-22 12:02:30 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2150 | error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read |
| 2151 | before any chroot is performed. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2152 | |
| 2153 | It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite |
| 2154 | errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy. |
| 2155 | This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set. |
| 2156 | |
Willy Tarreau | ae94d4d | 2011-05-11 16:28:49 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2157 | Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule. |
| 2158 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2159 | The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such |
| 2160 | as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies, |
| 2161 | force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error |
| 2162 | files returning the same contents as default errors. |
| 2163 | |
Willy Tarreau | 59140a2 | 2009-02-22 12:02:30 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2164 | The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which |
| 2165 | generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise |
| 2166 | not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid |
| 2167 | loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an |
| 2168 | error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is |
| 2169 | recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone. |
| 2170 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2171 | The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory. |
| 2172 | For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is |
| 2173 | chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2174 | simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2175 | 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL. |
| 2176 | |
| 2177 | See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303" |
| 2178 | |
Willy Tarreau | 59140a2 | 2009-02-22 12:02:30 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2179 | Example : |
| 2180 | errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http |
| 2181 | errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http |
| 2182 | errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http |
| 2183 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2184 | |
| 2185 | errorloc <code> <url> |
| 2186 | errorloc302 <code> <url> |
| 2187 | Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy |
| 2188 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2189 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 2190 | Arguments : |
| 2191 | <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of |
Willy Tarreau | ae94d4d | 2011-05-11 16:28:49 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2192 | generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504. |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2193 | |
| 2194 | <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain |
| 2195 | either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site, |
| 2196 | or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site. |
| 2197 | Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect |
| 2198 | loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500). |
| 2199 | |
| 2200 | It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite |
| 2201 | errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy. |
| 2202 | This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set. |
| 2203 | |
Willy Tarreau | ae94d4d | 2011-05-11 16:28:49 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2204 | Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule. |
| 2205 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2206 | Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the |
| 2207 | client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be |
| 2208 | quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL |
| 2209 | sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To |
| 2210 | workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303 |
| 2211 | status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET |
| 2212 | request. |
| 2213 | |
| 2214 | See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303" |
| 2215 | |
| 2216 | |
| 2217 | errorloc303 <code> <url> |
| 2218 | Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy |
| 2219 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2220 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 2221 | Arguments : |
| 2222 | <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of |
| 2223 | generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504. |
| 2224 | |
| 2225 | <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain |
| 2226 | either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site, |
| 2227 | or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site. |
| 2228 | Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect |
| 2229 | loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500). |
| 2230 | |
| 2231 | It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite |
| 2232 | errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy. |
| 2233 | This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set. |
| 2234 | |
Willy Tarreau | ae94d4d | 2011-05-11 16:28:49 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2235 | Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule. |
| 2236 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2237 | Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the |
| 2238 | client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This |
| 2239 | solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is |
| 2240 | possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2241 | it, but no such problem has been reported till now. |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2242 | |
| 2243 | See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" |
| 2244 | |
| 2245 | |
Willy Tarreau | 4de9149 | 2010-01-22 19:10:05 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2246 | force-persist { if | unless } <condition> |
| 2247 | Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers |
| 2248 | May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2249 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 2250 | |
| 2251 | By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to |
| 2252 | force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches |
| 2253 | to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little |
| 2254 | possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially |
| 2255 | marked down for maintenance operations. |
| 2256 | |
| 2257 | The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based |
| 2258 | conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of |
| 2259 | a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a |
| 2260 | server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially |
| 2261 | configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could |
| 2262 | use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has |
| 2263 | the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test |
| 2264 | page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service |
| 2265 | to the world by returning a valid response to health checks. |
| 2266 | |
| 2267 | The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an |
| 2268 | "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this |
| 2269 | is used. |
| 2270 | |
Cyril Bonté | 0d4bf01 | 2010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2271 | See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist", |
Cyril Bonté | a8e7bbc | 2010-04-25 22:29:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2272 | and section 7 about ACL usage. |
Willy Tarreau | 4de9149 | 2010-01-22 19:10:05 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2273 | |
| 2274 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2275 | fullconn <conns> |
| 2276 | Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn |
| 2277 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2278 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 2279 | Arguments : |
| 2280 | <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the |
| 2281 | servers use the maximal number of connections. |
| 2282 | |
Willy Tarreau | 198a744 | 2008-01-17 12:05:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2283 | When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2284 | of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a |
Willy Tarreau | 198a744 | 2008-01-17 12:05:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2285 | "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2286 | load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections, |
| 2287 | never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both |
| 2288 | values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This |
| 2289 | makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but |
| 2290 | push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2291 | exceptional loads. |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2292 | |
Willy Tarreau | fbb7842 | 2011-06-05 15:38:35 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2293 | Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to |
| 2294 | 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this |
| 2295 | backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset. |
| 2296 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2297 | Example : |
| 2298 | # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each |
| 2299 | # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000 |
| 2300 | # connections. |
| 2301 | backend dynamic |
| 2302 | fullconn 10000 |
| 2303 | server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000 |
| 2304 | server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000 |
| 2305 | |
| 2306 | See also : "maxconn", "server" |
| 2307 | |
| 2308 | |
| 2309 | grace <time> |
| 2310 | Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop |
| 2311 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
Cyril Bonté | 99ed327 | 2010-01-24 23:29:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2312 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2313 | Arguments : |
| 2314 | <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance |
| 2315 | will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening |
| 2316 | when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal. |
| 2317 | |
| 2318 | This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order. |
| 2319 | This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2320 | external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2321 | needed by the equipment to detect the failure. |
| 2322 | |
| 2323 | Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter, |
| 2324 | and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than |
| 2325 | simplify it. |
| 2326 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2327 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6b2e11b | 2009-10-01 07:52:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2328 | hash-type <method> |
| 2329 | Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers |
| 2330 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2331 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 2332 | Arguments : |
| 2333 | map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers. |
| 2334 | The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will |
| 2335 | be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be |
| 2336 | ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also, |
| 2337 | since a server is selected by its position in the array, most |
| 2338 | mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means |
| 2339 | that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added |
| 2340 | to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different |
| 2341 | servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance. |
| 2342 | |
Willy Tarreau | 798a39c | 2010-11-24 15:04:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2343 | avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described |
| 2344 | above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the |
| 2345 | mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most |
| 2346 | situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based |
| 2347 | hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of |
| 2348 | the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers |
| 2349 | multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to |
| 2350 | this value. |
| 2351 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6b2e11b | 2009-10-01 07:52:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2352 | consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each |
| 2353 | server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest |
| 2354 | server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing |
| 2355 | weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the |
| 2356 | slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server |
| 2357 | goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server |
| 2358 | is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are |
| 2359 | redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches. |
| 2360 | However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very |
| 2361 | smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's |
| 2362 | weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order |
| 2363 | to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is |
| 2364 | important that all servers have the same IDs. |
| 2365 | |
| 2366 | The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. |
| 2367 | |
| 2368 | See also : "balance", "server" |
| 2369 | |
| 2370 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2371 | http-check disable-on-404 |
| 2372 | Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks |
| 2373 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2374 | yes | no | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2375 | Arguments : none |
| 2376 | |
| 2377 | When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be |
| 2378 | excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent |
| 2379 | connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators |
| 2380 | to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note |
| 2381 | that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not |
| 2382 | generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it |
| 2383 | will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page |
| 2384 | reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this |
Willy Tarreau | bd74154 | 2010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2385 | option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option |
| 2386 | is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404 |
| 2387 | responses will still be considered as soft-stop. |
| 2388 | |
| 2389 | See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect" |
| 2390 | |
| 2391 | |
| 2392 | http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern> |
| 2393 | Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes |
| 2394 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
Willy Tarreau | 1ee51a6 | 2011-08-19 20:04:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2395 | yes | no | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | bd74154 | 2010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2396 | Arguments : |
| 2397 | <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the |
| 2398 | response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2399 | "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an |
Willy Tarreau | bd74154 | 2010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2400 | exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed |
| 2401 | between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more |
| 2402 | details on the supported keywords. |
| 2403 | |
| 2404 | <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular |
| 2405 | expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped |
| 2406 | with the usual backslash ('\'). |
| 2407 | |
| 2408 | By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx |
| 2409 | are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used, |
| 2410 | it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check" |
| 2411 | statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times |
| 2412 | out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are : |
| 2413 | |
| 2414 | status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code. |
| 2415 | A health check respose will be considered valid if the |
| 2416 | response's status code is exactly this string. If the |
| 2417 | "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response |
| 2418 | will be considered invalid if the status code matches. |
| 2419 | |
| 2420 | rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code. |
| 2421 | A health check respose will be considered valid if the |
| 2422 | response's status code matches the expression. If the |
| 2423 | "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response |
| 2424 | will be considered invalid if the status code matches. |
| 2425 | This is mostly used to check for multiple codes. |
| 2426 | |
| 2427 | string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body. |
| 2428 | A health check respose will be considered valid if the |
| 2429 | response's body contains this exact string. If the |
| 2430 | "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response |
| 2431 | will be considered invalid if the body contains this |
| 2432 | string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at |
| 2433 | the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a |
| 2434 | specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack |
| 2435 | trace). |
| 2436 | |
| 2437 | rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body. |
| 2438 | A health check respose will be considered valid if the |
| 2439 | response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring" |
| 2440 | keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be |
| 2441 | considered invalid if the body matches the expression. |
| 2442 | This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end |
| 2443 | of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific |
| 2444 | error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace). |
| 2445 | |
| 2446 | It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size |
| 2447 | defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes. |
| 2448 | Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using |
| 2449 | "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is |
| 2450 | possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable. |
| 2451 | However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can |
| 2452 | waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that |
| 2453 | it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. |
| 2454 | |
| 2455 | Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404", |
| 2456 | then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404. |
| 2457 | |
| 2458 | Examples : |
| 2459 | # only accept status 200 as valid |
Willy Tarreau | 8f2a1e7 | 2011-01-06 16:36:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2460 | http-check expect status 200 |
Willy Tarreau | bd74154 | 2010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2461 | |
| 2462 | # consider SQL errors as errors |
Willy Tarreau | 8f2a1e7 | 2011-01-06 16:36:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2463 | http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error |
Willy Tarreau | bd74154 | 2010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2464 | |
| 2465 | # consider status 5xx only as errors |
Willy Tarreau | 8f2a1e7 | 2011-01-06 16:36:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2466 | http-check expect ! rstatus ^5 |
Willy Tarreau | bd74154 | 2010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2467 | |
| 2468 | # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html |
Willy Tarreau | 8f2a1e7 | 2011-01-06 16:36:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2469 | http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html> |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2470 | |
Willy Tarreau | bd74154 | 2010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2471 | See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2472 | |
| 2473 | |
Willy Tarreau | ef78104 | 2010-01-27 11:53:01 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2474 | http-check send-state |
| 2475 | Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks |
| 2476 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2477 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 2478 | Arguments : none |
| 2479 | |
| 2480 | When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header |
| 2481 | "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server |
| 2482 | how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is |
| 2483 | manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether |
| 2484 | haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm. |
| 2485 | |
| 2486 | The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which |
| 2487 | is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid |
| 2488 | checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats |
| 2489 | interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in |
| 2490 | no specific order some values available in the stats interface : |
| 2491 | - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash |
| 2492 | ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is |
| 2493 | checked in multiple backends. |
| 2494 | |
| 2495 | - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the |
| 2496 | global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified. |
| 2497 | |
| 2498 | - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/") |
| 2499 | and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This |
| 2500 | helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this |
| 2501 | one fails. |
| 2502 | |
| 2503 | - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections |
| 2504 | on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of |
| 2505 | connections on all servers of the same backend. |
| 2506 | |
| 2507 | - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the |
| 2508 | server's queue. |
| 2509 | |
| 2510 | Example of a header received by the application server : |
| 2511 | >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \ |
| 2512 | scur=13/22; qcur=0 |
| 2513 | |
| 2514 | See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" |
| 2515 | |
Cyril Bonté | 2be1b3f | 2010-09-30 23:46:30 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2516 | http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] } |
Cyril Bonté | f0c6061 | 2010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2517 | [ { if | unless } <condition> ] |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2518 | Access control for Layer 7 requests |
| 2519 | |
| 2520 | May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2521 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 2522 | |
| 2523 | These set of options allow to fine control access to a |
| 2524 | frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl. |
| 2525 | First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final. |
Cyril Bonté | 2be1b3f | 2010-09-30 23:46:30 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2526 | For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is |
| 2527 | performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2528 | should be asked to enter a username and password. |
| 2529 | |
| 2530 | There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per |
| 2531 | instance. |
| 2532 | |
| 2533 | Example: |
Cyril Bonté | 78caf84 | 2010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2534 | acl nagios src 192.168.129.3 |
| 2535 | acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16 |
| 2536 | acl auth_ok http_auth(L1) |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2537 | |
Cyril Bonté | 78caf84 | 2010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2538 | http-request allow if nagios |
| 2539 | http-request allow if local_net auth_ok |
| 2540 | http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok |
| 2541 | http-request deny |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2542 | |
Cyril Bonté | 78caf84 | 2010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2543 | Example: |
| 2544 | acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1 |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2545 | |
Cyril Bonté | 78caf84 | 2010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2546 | http-request auth unless auth_ok |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2547 | |
Cyril Bonté | 2be1b3f | 2010-09-30 23:46:30 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2548 | See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 |
| 2549 | about ACL usage. |
Willy Tarreau | ef78104 | 2010-01-27 11:53:01 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2550 | |
Mark Lamourine | c2247f0 | 2012-01-04 13:02:01 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2551 | http-send-name-header [<header>] |
| 2552 | Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header> |
| 2553 | |
| 2554 | May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2555 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 2556 | |
| 2557 | Arguments : |
| 2558 | |
| 2559 | <header> The header string to use to send the server name |
| 2560 | |
| 2561 | The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target |
| 2562 | server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name |
| 2563 | is added with the header string proved. |
| 2564 | |
| 2565 | See also : "server" |
| 2566 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f58a962 | 2008-02-23 01:19:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2567 | id <value> |
Willy Tarreau | 53fb4ae | 2009-10-04 23:04:08 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2568 | Set a persistent ID to a proxy. |
| 2569 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2570 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 2571 | Arguments : none |
| 2572 | |
| 2573 | Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive. |
| 2574 | An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned |
| 2575 | value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics. |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f58a962 | 2008-02-23 01:19:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2576 | |
| 2577 | |
Cyril Bonté | 0d4bf01 | 2010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2578 | ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition> |
| 2579 | Declare a condition to ignore persistence |
| 2580 | May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2581 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 2582 | |
| 2583 | By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing |
| 2584 | the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up |
| 2585 | and running). |
| 2586 | |
| 2587 | The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based |
| 2588 | conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence. |
| 2589 | This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which |
| 2590 | oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable |
| 2591 | persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots). |
| 2592 | |
| 2593 | Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as |
| 2594 | the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored. |
| 2595 | |
| 2596 | The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an |
| 2597 | "unless" condition is met. |
| 2598 | |
| 2599 | See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage. |
| 2600 | |
| 2601 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2602 | log global |
Willy Tarreau | f7edefa | 2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2603 | log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]] |
William Lallemand | 0f99e34 | 2011-10-12 17:50:54 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2604 | no log |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2605 | Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic. |
| 2606 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2607 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
William Lallemand | 0f99e34 | 2011-10-12 17:50:54 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2608 | |
| 2609 | Prefix : |
| 2610 | no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example, |
| 2611 | if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This |
| 2612 | prefix does not allow arguments. |
| 2613 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2614 | Arguments : |
| 2615 | global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the |
| 2616 | same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global" |
| 2617 | replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log |
| 2618 | entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global" |
| 2619 | statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other |
| 2620 | parameter. |
| 2621 | |
| 2622 | <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as |
| 2623 | for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of : |
| 2624 | |
| 2625 | - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP |
| 2626 | port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the |
| 2627 | standard syslog port). |
| 2628 | |
David du Colombier | 24bb5f5 | 2011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2629 | - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP |
| 2630 | port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the |
| 2631 | standard syslog port). |
| 2632 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2633 | - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind |
| 2634 | considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible |
| 2635 | inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is |
| 2636 | appropriately writeable). |
| 2637 | |
| 2638 | <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities : |
| 2639 | |
| 2640 | kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news |
| 2641 | uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2 |
| 2642 | local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7 |
| 2643 | |
| 2644 | <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By |
| 2645 | default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only |
| 2646 | messages with a severity at least as important as this level |
Willy Tarreau | f7edefa | 2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2647 | will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it |
| 2648 | is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will |
| 2649 | be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg" |
| 2650 | messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations. |
| 2651 | Eight levels are known : |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2652 | |
| 2653 | emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug |
| 2654 | |
William Lallemand | 0f99e34 | 2011-10-12 17:50:54 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2655 | It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to |
| 2656 | log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries |
| 2657 | from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info". |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2658 | |
| 2659 | However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes |
| 2660 | will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up, |
| 2661 | "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service |
| 2662 | termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down. |
| 2663 | |
| 2664 | Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before |
| 2665 | being emitted. |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2666 | |
| 2667 | Example : |
| 2668 | log global |
Willy Tarreau | f7edefa | 2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2669 | log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events |
| 2670 | log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2671 | |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2672 | log-format <string> |
| 2673 | Allows you to custom a log line. |
| 2674 | |
| 2675 | See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4) |
| 2676 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2677 | |
| 2678 | maxconn <conns> |
| 2679 | Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend |
| 2680 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2681 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 2682 | Arguments : |
| 2683 | <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will |
| 2684 | accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system |
| 2685 | in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection |
| 2686 | closes. |
| 2687 | |
| 2688 | If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit |
| 2689 | very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the |
| 2690 | clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the |
| 2691 | global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers |
| 2692 | of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being |
| 2693 | consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped |
| 2694 | with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if |
| 2695 | properly tuned. |
| 2696 | |
| 2697 | Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers |
| 2698 | are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise |
| 2699 | to assign them some reasonable connection limits. |
| 2700 | |
| 2701 | See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn" |
| 2702 | |
| 2703 | |
| 2704 | mode { tcp|http|health } |
| 2705 | Set the running mode or protocol of the instance |
| 2706 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2707 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 2708 | Arguments : |
| 2709 | tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection |
| 2710 | will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7 |
| 2711 | examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It |
| 2712 | should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ... |
| 2713 | |
| 2714 | http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be |
| 2715 | analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request |
| 2716 | which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering, |
| 2717 | processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which |
| 2718 | brings HAProxy most of its value. |
| 2719 | |
| 2720 | health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK" |
| 2721 | to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be |
| 2722 | logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health |
| 2723 | checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as |
| 2724 | it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or |
| 2725 | HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword. |
| 2726 | |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2727 | When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the |
| 2728 | backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration |
| 2729 | will be refused. |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2730 | |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2731 | Example : |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2732 | defaults http_instances |
| 2733 | mode http |
| 2734 | |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2735 | See also : "monitor", "monitor-net" |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2736 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2737 | |
Cyril Bonté | f0c6061 | 2010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2738 | monitor fail { if | unless } <condition> |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2739 | Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2740 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2741 | no | yes | yes | no |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2742 | Arguments : |
| 2743 | if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied, |
| 2744 | and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2745 | combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2746 | are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a |
| 2747 | backend and its backup. |
| 2748 | |
| 2749 | unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is |
| 2750 | satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be |
| 2751 | based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active |
| 2752 | servers in a list of backends. |
| 2753 | |
| 2754 | This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor |
| 2755 | request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries |
| 2756 | the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the |
| 2757 | conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is |
| 2758 | very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base |
| 2759 | routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by |
| 2760 | haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv" |
Willy Tarreau | ae94d4d | 2011-05-11 16:28:49 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2761 | criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status |
| 2762 | messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2763 | |
| 2764 | Example: |
| 2765 | frontend www |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2766 | mode http |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2767 | acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 |
| 2768 | acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2 |
| 2769 | monitor-uri /site_alive |
| 2770 | monitor fail if site_dead |
| 2771 | |
Willy Tarreau | ae94d4d | 2011-05-11 16:28:49 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2772 | See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc" |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2773 | |
| 2774 | |
| 2775 | monitor-net <source> |
| 2776 | Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests |
| 2777 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2778 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 2779 | Arguments : |
| 2780 | <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to |
| 2781 | get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4 |
| 2782 | address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/') |
| 2783 | followed by a mask. |
| 2784 | |
| 2785 | In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause |
| 2786 | the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2787 | equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2788 | forwarding the connection to a remote server. |
| 2789 | |
| 2790 | In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be |
| 2791 | accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request, |
| 2792 | then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally |
| 2793 | enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and |
| 2794 | running without forwarding the request to a backend server. |
| 2795 | |
| 2796 | Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor |
| 2797 | divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended |
| 2798 | purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component, |
| 2799 | nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on |
| 2800 | requests caught by "monitor-net". |
| 2801 | |
Willy Tarreau | 95cd283 | 2010-03-04 23:36:33 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2802 | Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in |
| 2803 | a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered. |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2804 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2805 | Example : |
| 2806 | # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us. |
| 2807 | frontend www |
| 2808 | monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31 |
| 2809 | |
| 2810 | See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri" |
| 2811 | |
| 2812 | |
| 2813 | monitor-uri <uri> |
| 2814 | Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests |
| 2815 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2816 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 2817 | Arguments : |
| 2818 | <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's |
| 2819 | health status instead of forwarding the request. |
| 2820 | |
| 2821 | When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend, |
| 2822 | HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either |
| 2823 | "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure |
| 2824 | conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any |
| 2825 | front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without |
| 2826 | forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the |
| 2827 | version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid |
| 2828 | at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend. |
| 2829 | |
| 2830 | Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor |
| 2831 | divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended |
| 2832 | purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component, |
| 2833 | nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using |
| 2834 | "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check |
| 2835 | can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend). |
| 2836 | |
| 2837 | Example : |
| 2838 | # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status |
| 2839 | frontend www |
| 2840 | mode http |
| 2841 | monitor-uri /haproxy_test |
| 2842 | |
| 2843 | See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net" |
| 2844 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2845 | |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2846 | option abortonclose |
| 2847 | no option abortonclose |
| 2848 | Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues. |
| 2849 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2850 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 2851 | Arguments : none |
| 2852 | |
| 2853 | In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond. |
| 2854 | The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will |
| 2855 | increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session |
| 2856 | response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will |
Willy Tarreau | 198a744 | 2008-01-17 12:05:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2857 | often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2858 | the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the |
| 2859 | request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error |
| 2860 | encountered while delivering the response. |
| 2861 | |
| 2862 | As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output |
| 2863 | close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider |
| 2864 | that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for |
| 2865 | the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users |
| 2866 | do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at |
| 2867 | all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2868 | support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2869 | hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel |
Willy Tarreau | 198a744 | 2008-01-17 12:05:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2870 | to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2871 | of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely |
| 2872 | low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while |
| 2873 | still not served and not pollute the servers. |
| 2874 | |
| 2875 | In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option |
| 2876 | "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP |
| 2877 | compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is |
| 2878 | specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while |
| 2879 | it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or |
| 2880 | during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged |
| 2881 | the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load |
| 2882 | on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2883 | reduces the response time for other users. |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2884 | |
| 2885 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 2886 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 2887 | |
| 2888 | See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters |
| 2889 | |
| 2890 | |
Willy Tarreau | 4076a15 | 2009-04-02 15:18:36 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2891 | option accept-invalid-http-request |
| 2892 | no option accept-invalid-http-request |
| 2893 | Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing |
| 2894 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2895 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 2896 | Arguments : none |
| 2897 | |
| 2898 | By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This |
| 2899 | means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an |
| 2900 | error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such |
| 2901 | forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server |
| 2902 | weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or |
| 2903 | server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration, |
| 2904 | implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case, |
| 2905 | it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character |
Willy Tarreau | 422246e | 2012-01-07 23:54:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2906 | even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the |
| 2907 | list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and |
| 2908 | chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96 |
| 2909 | ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are |
| 2910 | not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The |
| 2911 | remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. |
Willy Tarreau | 4076a15 | 2009-04-02 15:18:36 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2912 | |
| 2913 | This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs |
| 2914 | and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has |
| 2915 | been confirmed. |
| 2916 | |
| 2917 | When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in |
| 2918 | requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later |
Willy Tarreau | 422246e | 2012-01-07 23:54:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2919 | analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly, |
| 2920 | requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this |
Willy Tarreau | 4076a15 | 2009-04-02 15:18:36 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2921 | also helps confirming that the issue has been solved. |
| 2922 | |
| 2923 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 2924 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 2925 | |
| 2926 | See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the |
| 2927 | stats socket. |
| 2928 | |
| 2929 | |
| 2930 | option accept-invalid-http-response |
| 2931 | no option accept-invalid-http-response |
| 2932 | Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing |
| 2933 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2934 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 2935 | Arguments : none |
| 2936 | |
| 2937 | By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This |
| 2938 | means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an |
| 2939 | error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such |
| 2940 | forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server |
| 2941 | weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or |
| 2942 | server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration, |
| 2943 | implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case, |
| 2944 | it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character |
| 2945 | even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. |
| 2946 | |
| 2947 | This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs |
| 2948 | and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has |
| 2949 | been confirmed. |
| 2950 | |
| 2951 | When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in |
| 2952 | responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit |
| 2953 | later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. |
| 2954 | Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved. |
| 2955 | |
| 2956 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 2957 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 2958 | |
| 2959 | See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the |
| 2960 | stats socket. |
| 2961 | |
| 2962 | |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2963 | option allbackups |
| 2964 | no option allbackups |
| 2965 | Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one |
| 2966 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2967 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 2968 | Arguments : none |
| 2969 | |
| 2970 | By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal |
| 2971 | servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups |
| 2972 | at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled, |
| 2973 | the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal |
| 2974 | ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the |
| 2975 | servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority |
| 2976 | order between the backup servers anymore. |
| 2977 | |
| 2978 | This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a |
| 2979 | "sorry" page when an application is completely offline. |
| 2980 | |
| 2981 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 2982 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 2983 | |
| 2984 | |
| 2985 | option checkcache |
| 2986 | no option checkcache |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2987 | Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2988 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2989 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 2990 | Arguments : none |
| 2991 | |
| 2992 | Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not |
| 2993 | always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2994 | be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2995 | high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same |
| 2996 | caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let |
Willy Tarreau | 3c92c5f | 2011-08-28 09:45:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2997 | some sensitive session information go in the wild. |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2998 | |
| 2999 | The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3000 | strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It |
Willy Tarreau | 198a744 | 2008-01-17 12:05:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3001 | carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3002 | response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side |
| 3003 | proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered |
Willy Tarreau | 198a744 | 2008-01-17 12:05:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3004 | to the client are : |
| 3005 | - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ; |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3006 | - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410, |
Willy Tarreau | 198a744 | 2008-01-17 12:05:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3007 | provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ; |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3008 | - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not |
| 3009 | set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ; |
| 3010 | - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header |
| 3011 | - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header |
| 3012 | - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header |
| 3013 | - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header |
| 3014 | - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header |
| 3015 | - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header |
| 3016 | - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header |
| 3017 | - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header |
| 3018 | (allowing other fields after set-cookie) |
| 3019 | |
| 3020 | If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked |
Willy Tarreau | 198a744 | 2008-01-17 12:05:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3021 | just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway". |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3022 | The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3023 | during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3024 | that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed. |
| 3025 | |
| 3026 | Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested |
| 3027 | in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3028 | good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3029 | production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours. |
| 3030 | |
| 3031 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3032 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3033 | |
| 3034 | |
| 3035 | option clitcpka |
| 3036 | no option clitcpka |
| 3037 | Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side |
| 3038 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3039 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 3040 | Arguments : none |
| 3041 | |
| 3042 | When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and |
| 3043 | a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle |
| 3044 | periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate |
| 3045 | components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long. |
| 3046 | |
| 3047 | Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets |
| 3048 | to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between |
| 3049 | keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the |
| 3050 | operating system and its tuning parameters. |
| 3051 | |
| 3052 | It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor |
| 3053 | received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees |
| 3054 | them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives |
| 3055 | to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be |
| 3056 | forwarded to the other side of the proxy. |
| 3057 | |
| 3058 | Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive. |
| 3059 | |
| 3060 | Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the |
| 3061 | client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are |
| 3062 | noticed between HAProxy and a client. |
| 3063 | |
| 3064 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3065 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3066 | |
| 3067 | See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka" |
| 3068 | |
| 3069 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3070 | option contstats |
| 3071 | Enable continuous traffic statistics updates |
| 3072 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3073 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 3074 | Arguments : none |
| 3075 | |
| 3076 | By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented |
| 3077 | only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small |
| 3078 | objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or |
| 3079 | with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like |
| 3080 | a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously, |
| 3081 | during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so |
| 3082 | it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%). |
| 3083 | |
| 3084 | |
Willy Tarreau | c9bd0cc | 2009-05-10 11:57:02 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3085 | option dontlog-normal |
| 3086 | no option dontlog-normal |
| 3087 | Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections |
| 3088 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3089 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 3090 | Arguments : none |
| 3091 | |
| 3092 | There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second |
| 3093 | and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn |
| 3094 | logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that |
| 3095 | normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor |
| 3096 | redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP |
| 3097 | mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be |
| 3098 | logged. |
| 3099 | |
| 3100 | It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to |
| 3101 | complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you |
| 3102 | need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead. |
| 3103 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3104 | See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about |
Willy Tarreau | c9bd0cc | 2009-05-10 11:57:02 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3105 | logging. |
| 3106 | |
| 3107 | |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3108 | option dontlognull |
| 3109 | no option dontlognull |
| 3110 | Enable or disable logging of null connections |
| 3111 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3112 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 3113 | Arguments : none |
| 3114 | |
| 3115 | In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to |
| 3116 | various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from |
| 3117 | another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a |
| 3118 | simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute |
| 3119 | the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate |
| 3120 | that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged, |
| 3121 | which typically corresponds to those probes. |
| 3122 | |
| 3123 | It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled |
| 3124 | environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities |
| 3125 | would not be logged. |
| 3126 | |
| 3127 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3128 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3129 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3130 | See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging. |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3131 | |
| 3132 | |
| 3133 | option forceclose |
| 3134 | no option forceclose |
| 3135 | Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred. |
| 3136 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
Willy Tarreau | a31e5df | 2009-12-30 01:10:35 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3137 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3138 | Arguments : none |
| 3139 | |
| 3140 | Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive |
| 3141 | the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not |
| 3142 | close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This |
| 3143 | causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high |
| 3144 | global session times in the logs. |
| 3145 | |
| 3146 | When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will |
Willy Tarreau | 82eeaf2 | 2009-12-29 12:09:05 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3147 | actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished |
Willy Tarreau | 0dfdf19 | 2010-01-05 11:33:11 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3148 | to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that |
| 3149 | this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which |
| 3150 | means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some |
| 3151 | resources earlier than with httpclose. |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3152 | |
Willy Tarreau | 8a8e1d9 | 2010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3153 | This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which |
| 3154 | will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause |
| 3155 | the connection to be closed once the whole response is received. |
| 3156 | |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3157 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3158 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3159 | |
Willy Tarreau | 8a8e1d9 | 2010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3160 | See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive" |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3161 | |
| 3162 | |
Willy Tarreau | 87cf514 | 2011-08-19 22:57:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3163 | option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ] |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3164 | Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers |
| 3165 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3166 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 3167 | Arguments : |
| 3168 | <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources |
| 3169 | matching <network> |
Ross West | af72a1d | 2008-08-03 10:51:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3170 | <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For" |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3171 | header name. |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3172 | |
| 3173 | Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as |
| 3174 | their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address |
| 3175 | is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header |
| 3176 | "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. |
| 3177 | This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this |
| 3178 | header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server |
| 3179 | must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See |
Ross West | af72a1d | 2008-08-03 10:51:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3180 | the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note |
| 3181 | that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really |
| 3182 | possible that the client has already brought one. |
| 3183 | |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3184 | The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace |
Ross West | af72a1d | 2008-08-03 10:51:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3185 | the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3186 | have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel), |
| 3187 | and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the |
Ross West | af72a1d | 2008-08-03 10:51:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3188 | "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers |
| 3189 | require "X-Cluster-Client-IP"). |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3190 | |
| 3191 | Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client |
| 3192 | access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is |
| 3193 | used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the |
| 3194 | header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword |
| 3195 | followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the |
| 3196 | network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with |
| 3197 | private networks or 127.0.0.1. |
| 3198 | |
Willy Tarreau | 87cf514 | 2011-08-19 22:57:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3199 | Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be |
| 3200 | added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted |
| 3201 | environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy |
| 3202 | are under the control of the end-user. |
| 3203 | |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3204 | This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at |
Ross West | af72a1d | 2008-08-03 10:51:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3205 | least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's |
| 3206 | setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if |
Willy Tarreau | 87cf514 | 2011-08-19 22:57:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3207 | both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of |
| 3208 | the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be |
| 3209 | mandatory, so it wins. |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3210 | |
Willy Tarreau | 87cf514 | 2011-08-19 22:57:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3211 | It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and |
| 3212 | only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first |
| 3213 | request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want. |
| 3214 | In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or |
| 3215 | "http-server-close" options is set when using this option. |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3216 | |
Ross West | af72a1d | 2008-08-03 10:51:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3217 | Examples : |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3218 | # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine |
| 3219 | frontend www |
| 3220 | mode http |
| 3221 | option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header |
| 3222 | |
Ross West | af72a1d | 2008-08-03 10:51:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3223 | # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client |
| 3224 | backend www |
| 3225 | mode http |
| 3226 | option forwardfor header X-Client |
| 3227 | |
Willy Tarreau | 87cf514 | 2011-08-19 22:57:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3228 | See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", |
| 3229 | "option forceclose" |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3230 | |
Willy Tarreau | 8a8e1d9 | 2010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3231 | |
Willy Tarreau | 96e3121 | 2011-05-30 18:10:30 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3232 | option http-no-delay |
| 3233 | no option http-no-delay |
| 3234 | Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP |
| 3235 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3236 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 3237 | Arguments : none |
| 3238 | |
| 3239 | In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity. |
| 3240 | Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay. |
| 3241 | There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP |
| 3242 | protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many |
| 3243 | interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is |
| 3244 | absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across |
| 3245 | most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through |
| 3246 | haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network |
| 3247 | optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for |
| 3248 | enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical |
| 3249 | delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with |
| 3250 | abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not |
| 3251 | affected. |
| 3252 | |
| 3253 | When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend |
| 3254 | used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to |
| 3255 | make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on |
| 3256 | the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via |
| 3257 | HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used |
| 3258 | by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application |
| 3259 | is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth |
| 3260 | usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high |
| 3261 | latency environments. |
| 3262 | |
| 3263 | |
Willy Tarreau | 8a8e1d9 | 2010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3264 | option http-pretend-keepalive |
| 3265 | no option http-pretend-keepalive |
| 3266 | Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not |
| 3267 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3268 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 3269 | Arguments : none |
| 3270 | |
| 3271 | When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy |
| 3272 | adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server. |
| 3273 | Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain |
| 3274 | from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this |
| 3275 | is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from |
| 3276 | maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or |
| 3277 | a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and |
| 3278 | consider the response complete. |
| 3279 | |
| 3280 | By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server |
| 3281 | believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back |
| 3282 | to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it |
| 3283 | will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the |
| 3284 | "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the |
| 3285 | connection is correctly closed on the server side. |
| 3286 | |
| 3287 | It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers |
| 3288 | will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet, |
| 3289 | and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the |
| 3290 | network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is |
| 3291 | worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly |
| 3292 | less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture, |
| 3293 | enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles. |
| 3294 | |
| 3295 | This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if |
| 3296 | at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled. |
Willy Tarreau | 22a9534 | 2010-09-29 14:31:41 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3297 | This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause |
| 3298 | keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the |
| 3299 | client. This practice is discouraged though. |
Willy Tarreau | 8a8e1d9 | 2010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3300 | |
| 3301 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3302 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3303 | |
| 3304 | See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close" |
| 3305 | |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3306 | |
Willy Tarreau | b608feb | 2010-01-02 22:47:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3307 | option http-server-close |
| 3308 | no option http-server-close |
| 3309 | Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side |
| 3310 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3311 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 3312 | Arguments : none |
| 3313 | |
Patrick Mezard | 9ec2ec4 | 2010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3314 | By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only |
| 3315 | analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting |
| 3316 | "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server |
| 3317 | side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on |
| 3318 | the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow |
| 3319 | network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server |
| 3320 | resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive |
| 3321 | capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they |
| 3322 | conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not |
| 3323 | always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the |
| 3324 | request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround |
| 3325 | consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive". |
Willy Tarreau | b608feb | 2010-01-02 22:47:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3326 | |
| 3327 | At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same |
| 3328 | session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end |
| 3329 | of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent |
| 3330 | waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the |
Willy Tarreau | b16a574 | 2010-01-10 14:46:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3331 | timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if |
| 3332 | not set. |
Willy Tarreau | b608feb | 2010-01-02 22:47:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3333 | |
| 3334 | This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if |
| 3335 | at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled. |
Willy Tarreau | 0dfdf19 | 2010-01-05 11:33:11 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3336 | It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option |
| 3337 | http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose" |
| 3338 | basically achieve the same result as "forceclose". |
Willy Tarreau | b608feb | 2010-01-02 22:47:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3339 | |
| 3340 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3341 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3342 | |
Patrick Mezard | 9ec2ec4 | 2010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3343 | See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive", |
| 3344 | "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model". |
Willy Tarreau | b608feb | 2010-01-02 22:47:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3345 | |
| 3346 | |
Willy Tarreau | 88d349d | 2010-01-25 12:15:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3347 | option http-use-proxy-header |
Cyril Bonté | f0c6061 | 2010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3348 | no option http-use-proxy-header |
Willy Tarreau | 88d349d | 2010-01-25 12:15:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3349 | Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection |
| 3350 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3351 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 3352 | Arguments : none |
| 3353 | |
| 3354 | While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the |
| 3355 | Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent |
| 3356 | connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied |
| 3357 | connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection |
| 3358 | header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between |
| 3359 | browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what |
| 3360 | haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on. |
| 3361 | |
| 3362 | By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use |
| 3363 | that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is |
| 3364 | defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The |
| 3365 | choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of |
| 3366 | one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note |
| 3367 | that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the |
| 3368 | request along its whole life. |
| 3369 | |
Willy Tarreau | 844a7e7 | 2010-01-31 21:46:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3370 | Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will |
| 3371 | automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a |
| 3372 | proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in |
| 3373 | front of an existing proxy. |
| 3374 | |
Willy Tarreau | 88d349d | 2010-01-25 12:15:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3375 | This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy. |
| 3376 | |
| 3377 | See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option |
| 3378 | http-server-close". |
| 3379 | |
| 3380 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3381 | option httpchk |
| 3382 | option httpchk <uri> |
| 3383 | option httpchk <method> <uri> |
| 3384 | option httpchk <method> <uri> <version> |
| 3385 | Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health |
| 3386 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3387 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 3388 | Arguments : |
| 3389 | <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set, |
| 3390 | the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server |
| 3391 | processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method |
| 3392 | may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard |
| 3393 | ones. |
| 3394 | |
| 3395 | <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / " |
| 3396 | which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be |
| 3397 | changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted. |
| 3398 | |
| 3399 | <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0" |
| 3400 | but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning |
| 3401 | it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is |
| 3402 | mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it |
| 3403 | after "\r\n" following the version string. |
| 3404 | |
| 3405 | By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP |
| 3406 | connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is |
| 3407 | sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are |
| 3408 | considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including |
| 3409 | the lack of any response. |
| 3410 | |
| 3411 | The port and interval are specified in the server configuration. |
| 3412 | |
| 3413 | This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with |
| 3414 | plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound |
| 3415 | to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. |
| 3416 | |
| 3417 | Examples : |
| 3418 | # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability |
| 3419 | # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80. |
| 3420 | backend https_relay |
| 3421 | mode tcp |
| 3422 | option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www |
| 3423 | server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80 |
| 3424 | |
| 3425 | See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check", |
Rauf Kuliyev | 38b4156 | 2011-01-04 15:14:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3426 | "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and |
| 3427 | "inter" server options. |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3428 | |
| 3429 | |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3430 | option httpclose |
| 3431 | no option httpclose |
| 3432 | Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing |
| 3433 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3434 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 3435 | Arguments : none |
| 3436 | |
Patrick Mezard | 9ec2ec4 | 2010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3437 | By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only |
| 3438 | analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option |
| 3439 | httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already |
| 3440 | set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to |
| 3441 | this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus |
| 3442 | resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header |
| 3443 | different from "close" will also be removed. |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3444 | |
| 3445 | It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not |
Willy Tarreau | 0dfdf19 | 2010-01-05 11:33:11 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3446 | close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this |
| 3447 | reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens |
| 3448 | it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the |
| 3449 | request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also |
| 3450 | releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for |
| 3451 | the client to acknowledge it. |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3452 | |
| 3453 | This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if |
| 3454 | at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled. |
| 3455 | If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose". |
Willy Tarreau | 0dfdf19 | 2010-01-05 11:33:11 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3456 | If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it |
| 3457 | basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose". |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3458 | |
| 3459 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3460 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3461 | |
Patrick Mezard | 9ec2ec4 | 2010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3462 | See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and |
| 3463 | "1.1. The HTTP transaction model". |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3464 | |
| 3465 | |
Emeric Brun | 3a058f3 | 2009-06-30 18:26:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3466 | option httplog [ clf ] |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3467 | Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers |
| 3468 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3469 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
Emeric Brun | 3a058f3 | 2009-06-30 18:26:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3470 | Arguments : |
| 3471 | clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be |
| 3472 | the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can |
| 3473 | use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific |
| 3474 | log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not |
| 3475 | extensible. |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3476 | |
| 3477 | By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the |
| 3478 | source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying |
| 3479 | "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, |
| 3480 | but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session |
| 3481 | status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the |
| 3482 | frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and |
| 3483 | ports. |
| 3484 | |
| 3485 | This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend. |
| 3486 | |
Emeric Brun | 3a058f3 | 2009-06-30 18:26:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3487 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3488 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying |
| 3489 | only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set |
| 3490 | by default. |
| 3491 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3492 | See also : section 8 about logging. |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3493 | |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3494 | |
| 3495 | option http_proxy |
| 3496 | no option http_proxy |
| 3497 | Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode |
| 3498 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3499 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 3500 | Arguments : none |
| 3501 | |
| 3502 | It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands |
| 3503 | basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case, |
| 3504 | it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy" |
| 3505 | set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to |
| 3506 | the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme. |
| 3507 | |
| 3508 | No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP |
| 3509 | addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited, |
| 3510 | it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last, |
| 3511 | if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be |
Cyril Bonté | 2409e68 | 2010-12-14 22:47:51 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3512 | needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3513 | be analyzed. |
| 3514 | |
| 3515 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3516 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3517 | |
| 3518 | Example : |
| 3519 | # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly. |
| 3520 | backend direct_forward |
| 3521 | option httpclose |
| 3522 | option http_proxy |
| 3523 | |
| 3524 | See also : "option httpclose" |
| 3525 | |
Willy Tarreau | 211ad24 | 2009-10-03 21:45:07 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3526 | |
Willy Tarreau | f27b5ea | 2009-10-03 22:01:18 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3527 | option independant-streams |
| 3528 | no option independant-streams |
| 3529 | Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions |
| 3530 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3531 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 3532 | Arguments : none |
| 3533 | |
| 3534 | By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the |
| 3535 | read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is |
| 3536 | activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should |
| 3537 | receive data or not. |
| 3538 | |
| 3539 | While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there |
| 3540 | exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the |
| 3541 | read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large |
| 3542 | timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the |
| 3543 | server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's |
| 3544 | socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way |
| 3545 | to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when |
| 3546 | the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself |
| 3547 | to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not |
| 3548 | happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the |
| 3549 | socket buffers. |
| 3550 | |
| 3551 | When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates |
| 3552 | on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When |
| 3553 | the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on |
| 3554 | data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from |
| 3555 | slow lines, so use it with caution. |
| 3556 | |
Willy Tarreau | ce887fd | 2012-05-12 12:50:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3557 | See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel" |
Willy Tarreau | f27b5ea | 2009-10-03 22:01:18 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3558 | |
| 3559 | |
Gabor Lekeny | b4c81e4 | 2010-09-29 18:17:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3560 | option ldap-check |
| 3561 | Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing |
| 3562 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3563 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 3564 | Arguments : none |
| 3565 | |
| 3566 | It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just |
| 3567 | testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an |
| 3568 | LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response |
| 3569 | is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message. |
| 3570 | |
| 3571 | The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success |
| 3572 | resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9). |
| 3573 | |
| 3574 | Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to |
| 3575 | configure it. |
| 3576 | |
| 3577 | Example : |
| 3578 | option ldap-check |
| 3579 | |
| 3580 | See also : "option httpchk" |
| 3581 | |
| 3582 | |
Willy Tarreau | 211ad24 | 2009-10-03 21:45:07 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3583 | option log-health-checks |
| 3584 | no option log-health-checks |
| 3585 | Enable or disable logging of health checks |
| 3586 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3587 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 3588 | Arguments : none |
| 3589 | |
| 3590 | Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what |
| 3591 | was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if |
| 3592 | server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount |
| 3593 | of additional information is limited. |
| 3594 | |
| 3595 | If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed |
| 3596 | when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED. |
| 3597 | |
| 3598 | See also: "log" and section 8 about logging. |
| 3599 | |
Willy Tarreau | c9bd0cc | 2009-05-10 11:57:02 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3600 | |
| 3601 | option log-separate-errors |
| 3602 | no option log-separate-errors |
| 3603 | Change log level for non-completely successful connections |
| 3604 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3605 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 3606 | Arguments : none |
| 3607 | |
| 3608 | Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy |
| 3609 | raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such |
| 3610 | as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The |
| 3611 | level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them |
| 3612 | separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to |
| 3613 | remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which |
| 3614 | provides very important information. |
| 3615 | |
| 3616 | Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per |
| 3617 | second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller |
| 3618 | error logs. |
| 3619 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3620 | See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about |
Willy Tarreau | c9bd0cc | 2009-05-10 11:57:02 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3621 | logging. |
| 3622 | |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3623 | |
| 3624 | option logasap |
| 3625 | no option logasap |
| 3626 | Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests |
| 3627 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3628 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 3629 | Arguments : none |
| 3630 | |
| 3631 | By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total |
| 3632 | transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects |
| 3633 | are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the |
| 3634 | logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server |
| 3635 | sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be |
| 3636 | the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount |
| 3637 | of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3638 | time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3639 | "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many |
| 3640 | bytes are expected to be transferred. |
| 3641 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3642 | Examples : |
| 3643 | listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80 |
| 3644 | mode http |
| 3645 | option httplog |
| 3646 | option logasap |
| 3647 | log 192.168.2.200 local3 |
| 3648 | |
| 3649 | >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \ |
| 3650 | haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \ |
| 3651 | static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \ |
| 3652 | "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0" |
| 3653 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3654 | See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3655 | logging. |
| 3656 | |
| 3657 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | 8776f1b | 2010-10-18 15:58:36 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3658 | option mysql-check [ user <username> ] |
| 3659 | Use MySQL health checks for server testing |
Hervé COMMOWICK | 698ae00 | 2010-01-12 09:25:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3660 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3661 | yes | no | yes | yes |
Hervé COMMOWICK | 8776f1b | 2010-10-18 15:58:36 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3662 | Arguments : |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3663 | <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL |
| 3664 | server. |
Hervé COMMOWICK | 8776f1b | 2010-10-18 15:58:36 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3665 | |
| 3666 | If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet, |
| 3667 | one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close |
| 3668 | MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or |
| 3669 | Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor |
| 3670 | aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization |
| 3671 | in the MySQL table, like this : |
| 3672 | |
| 3673 | USE mysql; |
| 3674 | INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>'); |
| 3675 | FLUSH PRIVILEGES; |
| 3676 | |
| 3677 | If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the |
| 3678 | check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or |
| 3679 | Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it |
| 3680 | can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough |
| 3681 | traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors" |
| 3682 | value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL |
| 3683 | "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted, |
| 3684 | the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get |
| 3685 | blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it. |
| 3686 | |
| 3687 | Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency. |
| 3688 | To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example. |
Hervé COMMOWICK | 698ae00 | 2010-01-12 09:25:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3689 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | 212f778 | 2011-06-10 14:05:59 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3690 | The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check. |
Hervé COMMOWICK | 698ae00 | 2010-01-12 09:25:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3691 | |
| 3692 | Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for |
| 3693 | various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging. |
| 3694 | When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when |
| 3695 | connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, |
| 3696 | which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server |
| 3697 | to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy. |
| 3698 | |
| 3699 | See also: "option httpchk" |
| 3700 | |
Rauf Kuliyev | 38b4156 | 2011-01-04 15:14:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3701 | option pgsql-check [ user <username> ] |
| 3702 | Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing |
| 3703 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3704 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 3705 | Arguments : |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3706 | <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to |
| 3707 | PostgreSQL server. |
Rauf Kuliyev | 38b4156 | 2011-01-04 15:14:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3708 | |
| 3709 | The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either |
| 3710 | Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful |
| 3711 | test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server. |
| 3712 | This check is identical with the "mysql-check". |
| 3713 | |
| 3714 | See also: "option httpchk" |
Hervé COMMOWICK | 698ae00 | 2010-01-12 09:25:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3715 | |
Willy Tarreau | a453bdd | 2008-01-08 19:50:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3716 | option nolinger |
| 3717 | no option nolinger |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3718 | Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close |
Willy Tarreau | a453bdd | 2008-01-08 19:50:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3719 | May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3720 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3721 | Arguments : none |
Willy Tarreau | a453bdd | 2008-01-08 19:50:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3722 | |
| 3723 | When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are |
| 3724 | physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is |
| 3725 | closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system, |
| 3726 | using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer |
| 3727 | connections. |
| 3728 | |
| 3729 | When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces |
| 3730 | the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus, |
| 3731 | the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has |
| 3732 | side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits |
| 3733 | getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about |
| 3734 | this too. |
| 3735 | |
| 3736 | For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely |
| 3737 | needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1 |
| 3738 | sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count). |
| 3739 | |
| 3740 | This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side |
| 3741 | where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend |
| 3742 | for servers. |
| 3743 | |
| 3744 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3745 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3746 | |
| 3747 | |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3748 | option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] |
| 3749 | Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers |
| 3750 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3751 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 3752 | Arguments : |
| 3753 | <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources |
| 3754 | matching <network> |
| 3755 | <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To" |
| 3756 | header name. |
| 3757 | |
| 3758 | Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can |
| 3759 | be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a |
| 3760 | complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will |
| 3761 | be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip |
| 3762 | addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be |
| 3763 | added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a |
| 3764 | value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be |
| 3765 | configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that |
| 3766 | only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really |
| 3767 | possible that the client has already brought one. |
| 3768 | |
| 3769 | The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace |
| 3770 | the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already |
| 3771 | have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need |
| 3772 | preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To" |
| 3773 | header and requires different one. |
| 3774 | |
| 3775 | Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client |
| 3776 | access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is |
| 3777 | used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the |
| 3778 | header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword |
| 3779 | followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the |
| 3780 | network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with |
| 3781 | private networks or 127.0.0.1. |
| 3782 | |
| 3783 | This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at |
| 3784 | least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's |
| 3785 | setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if |
| 3786 | both are defined. |
| 3787 | |
Willy Tarreau | 87cf514 | 2011-08-19 22:57:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3788 | It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and |
| 3789 | only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first |
| 3790 | request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want. |
| 3791 | In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or |
| 3792 | "http-server-close" options is set when using this option. |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3793 | |
| 3794 | Examples : |
| 3795 | # Original Destination address |
| 3796 | frontend www |
| 3797 | mode http |
| 3798 | option originalto except 127.0.0.1 |
| 3799 | |
| 3800 | # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst |
| 3801 | backend www |
| 3802 | mode http |
| 3803 | option originalto header X-Client-Dst |
| 3804 | |
Willy Tarreau | 87cf514 | 2011-08-19 22:57:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3805 | See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", |
| 3806 | "option forceclose" |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3807 | |
| 3808 | |
Willy Tarreau | a453bdd | 2008-01-08 19:50:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3809 | option persist |
| 3810 | no option persist |
| 3811 | Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers |
| 3812 | May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3813 | yes | no | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3814 | Arguments : none |
Willy Tarreau | a453bdd | 2008-01-08 19:50:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3815 | |
| 3816 | When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead |
| 3817 | server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to |
| 3818 | force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist" |
| 3819 | if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme |
| 3820 | load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be |
| 3821 | directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be |
| 3822 | correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction |
| 3823 | with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to |
| 3824 | the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be |
| 3825 | redirected to another valid server. |
| 3826 | |
| 3827 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3828 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3829 | |
Willy Tarreau | 4de9149 | 2010-01-22 19:10:05 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3830 | See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist" |
Willy Tarreau | a453bdd | 2008-01-08 19:50:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3831 | |
| 3832 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 25b501a | 2008-01-06 16:36:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3833 | option redispatch |
| 3834 | no option redispatch |
| 3835 | Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure |
| 3836 | May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3837 | yes | no | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3838 | Arguments : none |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 25b501a | 2008-01-06 16:36:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3839 | |
| 3840 | In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may |
| 3841 | definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not |
| 3842 | be able to access the service anymore. |
| 3843 | |
| 3844 | Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their |
| 3845 | persistence and redistribute them to a working server. |
| 3846 | |
| 3847 | It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple |
| 3848 | connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero |
| 3849 | value. |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3850 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 25b501a | 2008-01-06 16:36:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3851 | This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and |
| 3852 | "redisp" keywords. |
| 3853 | |
| 3854 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3855 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3856 | |
Willy Tarreau | 4de9149 | 2010-01-22 19:10:05 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3857 | See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist" |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 25b501a | 2008-01-06 16:36:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3858 | |
Willy Tarreau | a453bdd | 2008-01-08 19:50:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3859 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | ec032d6 | 2011-08-05 16:23:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3860 | option redis-check |
| 3861 | Use redis health checks for server testing |
| 3862 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3863 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 3864 | Arguments : none |
| 3865 | |
| 3866 | It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead |
| 3867 | of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, |
| 3868 | a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to |
| 3869 | find the "+PONG" response message. |
| 3870 | |
| 3871 | Example : |
| 3872 | option redis-check |
| 3873 | |
| 3874 | See also : "option httpchk" |
| 3875 | |
| 3876 | |
Willy Tarreau | a453bdd | 2008-01-08 19:50:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3877 | option smtpchk |
| 3878 | option smtpchk <hello> <domain> |
| 3879 | Use SMTP health checks for server testing |
| 3880 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3881 | yes | no | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3882 | Arguments : |
Willy Tarreau | a453bdd | 2008-01-08 19:50:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3883 | <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can |
| 3884 | be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other |
| 3885 | values will be turned into the default command ("HELO"). |
| 3886 | |
| 3887 | <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be |
| 3888 | specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been |
| 3889 | specified. By default, "localhost" is used. |
| 3890 | |
| 3891 | When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP |
| 3892 | connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is |
| 3893 | "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes |
| 3894 | starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses, |
| 3895 | including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a |
| 3896 | dead server. |
| 3897 | |
| 3898 | This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the |
| 3899 | request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt, |
| 3900 | so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port |
| 3901 | 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration. |
| 3902 | |
| 3903 | Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for |
| 3904 | various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When |
| 3905 | possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when |
| 3906 | connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, |
| 3907 | which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in. |
| 3908 | |
| 3909 | Example : |
| 3910 | option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org |
| 3911 | |
| 3912 | See also : "option httpchk", "source" |
| 3913 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 25b501a | 2008-01-06 16:36:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3914 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | aeebf9b | 2009-10-04 15:43:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3915 | option socket-stats |
| 3916 | no option socket-stats |
| 3917 | |
| 3918 | Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket. |
| 3919 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3920 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 3921 | |
| 3922 | Arguments : none |
| 3923 | |
| 3924 | |
Willy Tarreau | ff4f82d | 2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3925 | option splice-auto |
| 3926 | no option splice-auto |
| 3927 | Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions |
| 3928 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3929 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 3930 | Arguments : none |
| 3931 | |
| 3932 | When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy |
| 3933 | will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to |
| 3934 | forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy |
| 3935 | uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3936 | not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used |
Willy Tarreau | ff4f82d | 2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3937 | are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This |
| 3938 | option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally |
| 3939 | disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it |
| 3940 | requires that there are enough spare pipes. |
| 3941 | |
| 3942 | Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which |
| 3943 | first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to |
| 3944 | transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus |
| 3945 | providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many |
| 3946 | early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this |
| 3947 | feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care. |
| 3948 | While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation, |
| 3949 | 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In |
| 3950 | case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice" |
| 3951 | keyword. |
| 3952 | |
| 3953 | Example : |
| 3954 | option splice-auto |
| 3955 | |
| 3956 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3957 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3958 | |
| 3959 | See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global |
| 3960 | options "nosplice" and "maxpipes" |
| 3961 | |
| 3962 | |
| 3963 | option splice-request |
| 3964 | no option splice-request |
| 3965 | Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests |
| 3966 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3967 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 3968 | Arguments : none |
| 3969 | |
| 3970 | When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy |
| 3971 | will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from |
| 3972 | the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there |
| 3973 | are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at |
| 3974 | compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice". |
| 3975 | Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes. |
| 3976 | |
| 3977 | Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations. |
| 3978 | |
| 3979 | Example : |
| 3980 | option splice-request |
| 3981 | |
| 3982 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3983 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3984 | |
| 3985 | See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options |
| 3986 | "nosplice" and "maxpipes" |
| 3987 | |
| 3988 | |
| 3989 | option splice-response |
| 3990 | no option splice-response |
| 3991 | Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses |
| 3992 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3993 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 3994 | Arguments : none |
| 3995 | |
| 3996 | When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy |
| 3997 | will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from |
| 3998 | the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there |
| 3999 | are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at |
| 4000 | compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice". |
| 4001 | Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes. |
| 4002 | |
| 4003 | Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations. |
| 4004 | |
| 4005 | Example : |
| 4006 | option splice-response |
| 4007 | |
| 4008 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 4009 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 4010 | |
| 4011 | See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options |
| 4012 | "nosplice" and "maxpipes" |
| 4013 | |
| 4014 | |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4015 | option srvtcpka |
| 4016 | no option srvtcpka |
| 4017 | Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side |
| 4018 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4019 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 4020 | Arguments : none |
| 4021 | |
| 4022 | When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and |
| 4023 | a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle |
| 4024 | periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate |
| 4025 | components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long. |
| 4026 | |
| 4027 | Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets |
| 4028 | to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between |
| 4029 | keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the |
| 4030 | operating system and its tuning parameters. |
| 4031 | |
| 4032 | It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor |
| 4033 | received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees |
| 4034 | them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives |
| 4035 | to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be |
| 4036 | forwarded to the other side of the proxy. |
| 4037 | |
| 4038 | Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive. |
| 4039 | |
| 4040 | Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the |
| 4041 | server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are |
| 4042 | noticed between HAProxy and a server. |
| 4043 | |
| 4044 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 4045 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 4046 | |
| 4047 | See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka" |
| 4048 | |
| 4049 | |
Willy Tarreau | a453bdd | 2008-01-08 19:50:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4050 | option ssl-hello-chk |
| 4051 | Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing |
| 4052 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4053 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 4054 | Arguments : none |
| 4055 | |
| 4056 | When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is |
| 4057 | possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing |
| 4058 | that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure |
| 4059 | SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to |
| 4060 | the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message. |
| 4061 | The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server |
| 4062 | hello message. |
| 4063 | |
| 4064 | All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages, |
| 4065 | and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello |
| 4066 | messages, which is appreciable. |
| 4067 | |
| 4068 | See also: "option httpchk" |
| 4069 | |
| 4070 | |
Willy Tarreau | 9ea05a7 | 2009-06-14 12:07:01 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4071 | option tcp-smart-accept |
| 4072 | no option tcp-smart-accept |
| 4073 | Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence |
| 4074 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4075 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 4076 | Arguments : none |
| 4077 | |
| 4078 | When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on |
| 4079 | behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the |
| 4080 | system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new |
| 4081 | connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we |
| 4082 | have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could |
| 4083 | very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response. |
| 4084 | |
| 4085 | For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid |
| 4086 | sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least |
| 4087 | Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway |
| 4088 | after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come. |
| 4089 | |
| 4090 | During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable |
| 4091 | this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex |
| 4092 | when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to |
| 4093 | fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept". |
| 4094 | |
| 4095 | It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying |
| 4096 | "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services |
| 4097 | such as SMTP where the server speaks first. |
| 4098 | |
| 4099 | It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case |
| 4100 | of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the |
| 4101 | "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword. |
| 4102 | |
Willy Tarreau | d88edf2 | 2009-06-14 15:48:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4103 | See also : "option tcp-smart-connect" |
| 4104 | |
| 4105 | |
| 4106 | option tcp-smart-connect |
| 4107 | no option tcp-smart-connect |
| 4108 | Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence |
| 4109 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4110 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 4111 | Arguments : none |
| 4112 | |
| 4113 | On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to |
| 4114 | immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly |
| 4115 | send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and |
| 4116 | thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they |
| 4117 | immediately get the request along with the incoming connection. |
| 4118 | |
| 4119 | This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend. |
| 4120 | It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more |
| 4121 | complex. |
| 4122 | |
| 4123 | It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first |
| 4124 | such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of |
| 4125 | the ACK, a normal ACK is sent. |
| 4126 | |
| 4127 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 4128 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 4129 | |
| 4130 | See also : "option tcp-smart-accept" |
| 4131 | |
Willy Tarreau | 9ea05a7 | 2009-06-14 12:07:01 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4132 | |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4133 | option tcpka |
| 4134 | Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides |
| 4135 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4136 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 4137 | Arguments : none |
| 4138 | |
| 4139 | When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and |
| 4140 | a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle |
| 4141 | periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate |
| 4142 | components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long. |
| 4143 | |
| 4144 | Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets |
| 4145 | to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between |
| 4146 | keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the |
| 4147 | operating system and its tuning parameters. |
| 4148 | |
| 4149 | It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor |
| 4150 | received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees |
| 4151 | them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives |
| 4152 | to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be |
| 4153 | forwarded to the other side of the proxy. |
| 4154 | |
| 4155 | Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive. |
| 4156 | |
| 4157 | Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both |
| 4158 | the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful |
| 4159 | only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a |
| 4160 | frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is |
| 4161 | used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this |
| 4162 | reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and |
| 4163 | "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and |
| 4164 | backends. |
| 4165 | |
| 4166 | See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka" |
| 4167 | |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4168 | |
| 4169 | option tcplog |
| 4170 | Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers |
| 4171 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4172 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 4173 | Arguments : none |
| 4174 | |
| 4175 | By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the |
| 4176 | source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying |
| 4177 | "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but |
| 4178 | not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections |
| 4179 | numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source |
| 4180 | address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to |
| 4181 | find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP |
| 4182 | proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete. |
| 4183 | |
| 4184 | This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend. |
| 4185 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4186 | See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging. |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4187 | |
| 4188 | |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4189 | option transparent |
| 4190 | no option transparent |
| 4191 | Enable client-side transparent proxying |
| 4192 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
Willy Tarreau | 4b1f859 | 2008-12-23 23:13:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4193 | yes | no | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4194 | Arguments : none |
| 4195 | |
| 4196 | This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3 |
| 4197 | load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming |
| 4198 | connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let |
| 4199 | this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is |
| 4200 | used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination |
| 4201 | IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another |
| 4202 | equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the |
| 4203 | appropriate server. |
| 4204 | |
| 4205 | Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy |
| 4206 | present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection. |
| 4207 | |
Willy Tarreau | a114605 | 2011-03-01 09:51:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4208 | See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4209 | "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword. |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4210 | |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4211 | |
Emeric Brun | 647caf1 | 2009-06-30 17:57:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4212 | persist rdp-cookie |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4213 | persist rdp-cookie(<name>) |
Emeric Brun | 647caf1 | 2009-06-30 17:57:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4214 | Enable RDP cookie-based persistence |
| 4215 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4216 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 4217 | Arguments : |
| 4218 | <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the |
Willy Tarreau | 61e28f2 | 2010-05-16 22:31:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4219 | default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no |
| 4220 | valid reason to change this name. |
Emeric Brun | 647caf1 | 2009-06-30 17:57:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4221 | |
| 4222 | This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie |
| 4223 | contains all information required to find the server in the list of known |
| 4224 | servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed |
| 4225 | and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server |
| 4226 | which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is |
| 4227 | forwarded to this server. |
| 4228 | |
| 4229 | Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the |
| 4230 | frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present |
| 4231 | in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie" |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4232 | load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in |
Emeric Brun | 647caf1 | 2009-06-30 17:57:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4233 | a single "listen" section. |
| 4234 | |
Willy Tarreau | 61e28f2 | 2010-05-16 22:31:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4235 | Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this |
| 4236 | RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means |
| 4237 | that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled. |
| 4238 | |
Emeric Brun | 647caf1 | 2009-06-30 17:57:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4239 | Example : |
| 4240 | listen tse-farm |
| 4241 | bind :3389 |
| 4242 | # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request |
| 4243 | tcp-request inspect-delay 5s |
| 4244 | tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE |
| 4245 | # apply RDP cookie persistence |
| 4246 | persist rdp-cookie |
| 4247 | # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie. |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4248 | # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too. |
Emeric Brun | 647caf1 | 2009-06-30 17:57:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4249 | balance rdp-cookie |
| 4250 | server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389 |
| 4251 | server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389 |
| 4252 | |
Simon Horman | ab814e0 | 2011-06-24 14:50:20 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 4253 | See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and |
| 4254 | the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function. |
Emeric Brun | 647caf1 | 2009-06-30 17:57:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4255 | |
| 4256 | |
Willy Tarreau | 3a7d207 | 2009-03-05 23:48:25 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4257 | rate-limit sessions <rate> |
| 4258 | Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend |
| 4259 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4260 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 4261 | Arguments : |
| 4262 | <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number |
| 4263 | of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend. |
| 4264 | |
| 4265 | When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it |
| 4266 | stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again. |
| 4267 | During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog |
| 4268 | (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are |
| 4269 | pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make |
| 4270 | sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword. |
| 4271 | |
| 4272 | This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks |
| 4273 | or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every |
| 4274 | millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately, |
| 4275 | no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold. |
| 4276 | |
| 4277 | Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max |
| 4278 | listen smtp |
| 4279 | mode tcp |
| 4280 | bind :25 |
| 4281 | rate-limit sessions 10 |
| 4282 | server 127.0.0.1:1025 |
| 4283 | |
Willy Tarreau | a17c2d9 | 2011-07-25 08:16:20 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4284 | Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed |
| 4285 | but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the |
| 4286 | "socket-stats" option is enabled. |
Willy Tarreau | 3a7d207 | 2009-03-05 23:48:25 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4287 | |
| 4288 | See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion. |
| 4289 | |
| 4290 | |
Willy Tarreau | f285f54 | 2010-01-03 20:03:03 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4291 | redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>] |
| 4292 | redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>] |
Willy Tarreau | b463dfb | 2008-06-07 23:08:56 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4293 | Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched |
| 4294 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4295 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 4296 | |
| 4297 | If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect |
Willy Tarreau | f285f54 | 2010-01-03 20:03:03 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4298 | response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally. |
Willy Tarreau | b463dfb | 2008-06-07 23:08:56 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4299 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0140f25 | 2008-11-19 21:07:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4300 | Arguments : |
| 4301 | <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into |
| 4302 | the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the |
| 4303 | "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the |
| 4304 | complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query" |
Willy Tarreau | fe651a5 | 2008-11-19 21:15:17 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4305 | option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to> |
| 4306 | equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted |
| 4307 | before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same |
| 4308 | URL. |
Willy Tarreau | 0140f25 | 2008-11-19 21:07:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4309 | |
| 4310 | <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection |
| 4311 | is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is |
| 4312 | used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and |
| 4313 | a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently" |
| 4314 | and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303 |
| 4315 | is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the |
| 4316 | location with a GET method. |
| 4317 | |
| 4318 | <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the |
| 4319 | expected behaviour of a redirection : |
| 4320 | |
| 4321 | - "drop-query" |
| 4322 | When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the |
| 4323 | location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful |
| 4324 | for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect |
| 4325 | with a location-type redirect. |
| 4326 | |
Willy Tarreau | 81e3b4f | 2010-01-10 00:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4327 | - "append-slash" |
| 4328 | This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect |
| 4329 | users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'. |
| 4330 | It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL. |
| 4331 | For this, a return code 301 is preferred. |
| 4332 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0140f25 | 2008-11-19 21:07:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4333 | - "set-cookie NAME[=value]" |
| 4334 | A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value") |
| 4335 | to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has |
| 4336 | been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other |
| 4337 | cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note |
| 4338 | that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is |
| 4339 | different from a cookie with an equal sign. |
| 4340 | |
| 4341 | - "clear-cookie NAME[=]" |
| 4342 | A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but |
| 4343 | with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to |
| 4344 | delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is |
| 4345 | important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a |
| 4346 | cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for |
| 4347 | that, because the browser makes the difference. |
Willy Tarreau | b463dfb | 2008-06-07 23:08:56 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4348 | |
| 4349 | Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS. |
| 4350 | acl clear dst_port 80 |
| 4351 | acl secure dst_port 8080 |
| 4352 | acl login_page url_beg /login |
Willy Tarreau | 0140f25 | 2008-11-19 21:07:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4353 | acl logout url_beg /logout |
Willy Tarreau | 79da469 | 2008-11-19 20:03:04 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4354 | acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+ |
Willy Tarreau | 0140f25 | 2008-11-19 21:07:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4355 | acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1 |
| 4356 | |
| 4357 | redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set |
Willy Tarreau | 79da469 | 2008-11-19 20:03:04 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4358 | redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure |
| 4359 | redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given |
| 4360 | redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure |
Willy Tarreau | 0140f25 | 2008-11-19 21:07:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4361 | redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout |
Willy Tarreau | b463dfb | 2008-06-07 23:08:56 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4362 | |
Willy Tarreau | 81e3b4f | 2010-01-10 00:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4363 | Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'. |
| 4364 | acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$ |
| 4365 | redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash |
| 4366 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4367 | See section 7 about ACL usage. |
Willy Tarreau | b463dfb | 2008-06-07 23:08:56 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4368 | |
| 4369 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 25b501a | 2008-01-06 16:36:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4370 | redisp (deprecated) |
| 4371 | redispatch (deprecated) |
| 4372 | Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure |
| 4373 | May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4374 | yes | no | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4375 | Arguments : none |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 25b501a | 2008-01-06 16:36:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4376 | |
| 4377 | In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may |
| 4378 | definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not |
| 4379 | be able to access the service anymore. |
| 4380 | |
| 4381 | Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and |
| 4382 | redistribute them to a working server. |
| 4383 | |
| 4384 | It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple |
| 4385 | connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero |
| 4386 | value. |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4387 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 25b501a | 2008-01-06 16:36:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4388 | This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new |
| 4389 | "option redispatch" instead. |
| 4390 | |
| 4391 | See also : "option redispatch" |
| 4392 | |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4393 | |
Willy Tarreau | 8abd4cd | 2010-01-31 14:30:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4394 | reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4395 | Add a header at the end of the HTTP request |
| 4396 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4397 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 4398 | Arguments : |
| 4399 | <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter |
| 4400 | must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4401 | 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4402 | |
Willy Tarreau | 8abd4cd | 2010-01-31 14:30:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4403 | <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it |
| 4404 | possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met. |
| 4405 | |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4406 | A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after |
| 4407 | the last header of an HTTP request. |
| 4408 | |
| 4409 | Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy, |
| 4410 | and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error |
| 4411 | responses. |
| 4412 | |
Willy Tarreau | 8abd4cd | 2010-01-31 14:30:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4413 | Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81 |
| 4414 | acl is-ssl dst_port 81 |
| 4415 | reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl |
| 4416 | |
| 4417 | See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 |
| 4418 | about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4419 | |
| 4420 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4421 | reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] |
| 4422 | reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4423 | Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression |
| 4424 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4425 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 4426 | Arguments : |
| 4427 | <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the |
| 4428 | request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis |
| 4429 | grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required. |
| 4430 | Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash |
| 4431 | ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The |
| 4432 | "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow" |
| 4433 | ignores case. |
| 4434 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4435 | <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it |
| 4436 | possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met. |
| 4437 | |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4438 | A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression |
| 4439 | <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would |
| 4440 | result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request |
| 4441 | headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4442 | header names are not. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4443 | |
| 4444 | It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies. |
| 4445 | Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs. |
| 4446 | |
| 4447 | Example : |
| 4448 | # allow www.* but refuse *.local |
| 4449 | reqiallow ^Host:\ www\. |
| 4450 | reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local |
| 4451 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4452 | See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and |
| 4453 | section 7 about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4454 | |
| 4455 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4456 | reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] |
| 4457 | reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4458 | Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request |
| 4459 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4460 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 4461 | Arguments : |
| 4462 | <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the |
| 4463 | request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis |
| 4464 | grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required. |
| 4465 | Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash |
| 4466 | ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel" |
| 4467 | keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case. |
| 4468 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4469 | <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it |
| 4470 | possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met. |
| 4471 | |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4472 | Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request |
| 4473 | will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted |
| 4474 | and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the |
| 4475 | next servers. |
| 4476 | |
| 4477 | Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy, |
| 4478 | and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error |
| 4479 | responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive. |
| 4480 | |
| 4481 | Example : |
| 4482 | # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie |
| 4483 | reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.* |
| 4484 | reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER= |
| 4485 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4486 | See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header |
| 4487 | manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4488 | |
| 4489 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4490 | reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] |
| 4491 | reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4492 | Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression |
| 4493 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4494 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 4495 | Arguments : |
| 4496 | <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the |
| 4497 | request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis |
| 4498 | grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required. |
| 4499 | Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash |
| 4500 | ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The |
| 4501 | "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores |
| 4502 | case. |
| 4503 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4504 | <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it |
| 4505 | possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met. |
| 4506 | |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4507 | A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression |
| 4508 | <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would |
| 4509 | result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request |
| 4510 | headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4511 | header names are not. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4512 | |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4513 | A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4514 | complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4515 | using ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4516 | |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4517 | It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies. |
| 4518 | Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs. |
| 4519 | |
| 4520 | Example : |
| 4521 | # refuse *.local, then allow www.* |
| 4522 | reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local |
| 4523 | reqiallow ^Host:\ www\. |
| 4524 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4525 | See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header |
| 4526 | manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4527 | |
| 4528 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4529 | reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] |
| 4530 | reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4531 | Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules |
| 4532 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4533 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 4534 | Arguments : |
| 4535 | <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the |
| 4536 | request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis |
| 4537 | grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required. |
| 4538 | Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash |
| 4539 | ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The |
| 4540 | "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores |
| 4541 | case. |
| 4542 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4543 | <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it |
| 4544 | possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met. |
| 4545 | |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4546 | A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression |
| 4547 | <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict. |
| 4548 | The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in |
| 4549 | mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not. |
| 4550 | |
| 4551 | It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies. |
| 4552 | Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs. |
| 4553 | |
| 4554 | Example : |
| 4555 | # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local" |
| 4556 | reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local |
| 4557 | reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local |
| 4558 | reqiallow ^Host:\ www\. |
| 4559 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4560 | See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header |
| 4561 | manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4562 | |
| 4563 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4564 | reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] |
| 4565 | reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4566 | Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line |
| 4567 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4568 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 4569 | Arguments : |
| 4570 | <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the |
| 4571 | request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis |
| 4572 | grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required. |
| 4573 | Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash |
| 4574 | ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep" |
| 4575 | keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case. |
| 4576 | |
| 4577 | <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter |
| 4578 | must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched |
| 4579 | pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N |
| 4580 | being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4581 | 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4582 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4583 | <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it |
| 4584 | possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met. |
| 4585 | |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4586 | Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both |
| 4587 | the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>. |
| 4588 | Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers. |
| 4589 | |
| 4590 | Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy, |
| 4591 | and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error |
| 4592 | responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough |
| 4593 | spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in |
| 4594 | request line are case-sensitive while header names are not. |
| 4595 | |
| 4596 | Example : |
| 4597 | # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path. |
Dmitry Sivachenko | 7823de3 | 2012-05-16 14:00:26 +0400 | [diff] [blame] | 4598 | reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2 |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4599 | # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name. |
| 4600 | reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www |
| 4601 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4602 | See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header |
| 4603 | manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4604 | |
| 4605 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4606 | reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] |
| 4607 | reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4608 | Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression |
| 4609 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4610 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 4611 | Arguments : |
| 4612 | <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the |
| 4613 | request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis |
| 4614 | grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required. |
| 4615 | Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash |
| 4616 | ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The |
| 4617 | "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit" |
| 4618 | ignores case. |
| 4619 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4620 | <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it |
| 4621 | possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met. |
| 4622 | |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4623 | A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression |
| 4624 | <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4625 | be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so |
| 4626 | that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will |
| 4627 | be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4628 | delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is |
| 4629 | not set. |
| 4630 | |
| 4631 | The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with |
| 4632 | identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections |
| 4633 | and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to |
| 4634 | come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly |
| 4635 | efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls. |
| 4636 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4637 | Examples : |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4638 | # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but |
| 4639 | # block all others. |
| 4640 | reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE) |
| 4641 | reqitarpit ^User-Agent: |
| 4642 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4643 | # block bad guys |
| 4644 | acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28 |
| 4645 | reqitarpit . if badguys |
| 4646 | |
| 4647 | See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header |
| 4648 | manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4649 | |
| 4650 | |
Willy Tarreau | e5c5ce9 | 2008-06-20 17:27:19 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4651 | retries <value> |
| 4652 | Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure |
| 4653 | May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4654 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 4655 | Arguments : |
| 4656 | <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on |
| 4657 | a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The |
| 4658 | default value is 3. |
| 4659 | |
| 4660 | It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of |
| 4661 | connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively |
| 4662 | been established to a server, there will be no more retry. |
| 4663 | |
| 4664 | In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting, |
| 4665 | a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs. |
| 4666 | |
| 4667 | When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another |
| 4668 | server even if a cookie references a different server. |
| 4669 | |
| 4670 | See also : "option redispatch" |
| 4671 | |
| 4672 | |
Willy Tarreau | fdb563c | 2010-01-31 15:43:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4673 | rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4674 | Add a header at the end of the HTTP response |
| 4675 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4676 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 4677 | Arguments : |
| 4678 | <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter |
| 4679 | must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4680 | 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4681 | |
Willy Tarreau | fdb563c | 2010-01-31 15:43:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4682 | <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it |
| 4683 | possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met. |
| 4684 | |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4685 | A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after |
| 4686 | the last header of an HTTP response. |
| 4687 | |
| 4688 | Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy, |
| 4689 | and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error |
| 4690 | responses. |
| 4691 | |
Willy Tarreau | fdb563c | 2010-01-31 15:43:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4692 | See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 |
| 4693 | about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4694 | |
| 4695 | |
Willy Tarreau | fdb563c | 2010-01-31 15:43:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4696 | rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] |
| 4697 | rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4698 | Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response |
| 4699 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4700 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 4701 | Arguments : |
| 4702 | <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the |
| 4703 | response line. This is an extended regular expression, so |
| 4704 | parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash |
| 4705 | is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using |
| 4706 | a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. |
| 4707 | The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel" |
| 4708 | ignores case. |
| 4709 | |
Willy Tarreau | fdb563c | 2010-01-31 15:43:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4710 | <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it |
| 4711 | possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met. |
| 4712 | |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4713 | Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response |
| 4714 | will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted |
Willy Tarreau | 3c92c5f | 2011-08-28 09:45:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4715 | and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4716 | client. |
| 4717 | |
| 4718 | Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy, |
| 4719 | and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error |
| 4720 | responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive. |
| 4721 | |
| 4722 | Example : |
| 4723 | # remove the Server header from responses |
| 4724 | reqidel ^Server:.* |
| 4725 | |
Willy Tarreau | fdb563c | 2010-01-31 15:43:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4726 | See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header |
| 4727 | manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4728 | |
| 4729 | |
Willy Tarreau | fdb563c | 2010-01-31 15:43:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4730 | rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] |
| 4731 | rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4732 | Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression |
| 4733 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4734 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 4735 | Arguments : |
| 4736 | <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the |
| 4737 | response line. This is an extended regular expression, so |
| 4738 | parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash |
| 4739 | is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using |
| 4740 | a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. |
| 4741 | The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny" |
| 4742 | ignores case. |
| 4743 | |
Willy Tarreau | fdb563c | 2010-01-31 15:43:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4744 | <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it |
| 4745 | possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met. |
| 4746 | |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4747 | A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression |
| 4748 | <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the |
| 4749 | response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not |
| 4750 | case-sensitive. |
| 4751 | |
| 4752 | Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4753 | block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it |
| 4754 | will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves |
| 4755 | any sensitive data. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4756 | |
| 4757 | It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies. |
| 4758 | Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs. |
| 4759 | |
| 4760 | Example : |
| 4761 | # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak |
| 4762 | rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word |
| 4763 | |
Willy Tarreau | fdb563c | 2010-01-31 15:43:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4764 | See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation |
| 4765 | and section 7 about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4766 | |
| 4767 | |
Willy Tarreau | fdb563c | 2010-01-31 15:43:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4768 | rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] |
| 4769 | rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4770 | Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line |
| 4771 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4772 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 4773 | Arguments : |
| 4774 | <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the |
| 4775 | response line. This is an extended regular expression, so |
| 4776 | parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash |
| 4777 | is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using |
| 4778 | a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. |
| 4779 | The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep" |
| 4780 | ignores case. |
| 4781 | |
| 4782 | <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter |
| 4783 | must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched |
| 4784 | pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N |
| 4785 | being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4786 | 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4787 | |
Willy Tarreau | fdb563c | 2010-01-31 15:43:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4788 | <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it |
| 4789 | possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met. |
| 4790 | |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4791 | Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both |
| 4792 | the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with |
| 4793 | <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers. |
| 4794 | |
| 4795 | Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy, |
| 4796 | and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error |
| 4797 | responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough |
| 4798 | spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names |
| 4799 | are not case-sensitive. |
| 4800 | |
| 4801 | Example : |
| 4802 | # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com" |
| 4803 | rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com |
| 4804 | |
Willy Tarreau | fdb563c | 2010-01-31 15:43:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4805 | See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header |
| 4806 | manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4807 | |
| 4808 | |
David du Colombier | 486df47 | 2011-03-17 10:40:26 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4809 | server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*] |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4810 | Declare a server in a backend |
| 4811 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4812 | no | no | yes | yes |
| 4813 | Arguments : |
| 4814 | <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will |
Mark Lamourine | c2247f0 | 2012-01-04 13:02:01 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4815 | appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-server-name" is |
| 4816 | set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server. |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4817 | |
David du Colombier | 486df47 | 2011-03-17 10:40:26 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4818 | <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a |
| 4819 | resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved |
| 4820 | during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning. |
| 4821 | It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP |
Willy Tarreau | d669a4f | 2010-07-13 14:49:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4822 | address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in |
| 4823 | transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is |
| 4824 | intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination |
| 4825 | address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does |
| 4826 | except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and |
| 4827 | to report statistics. |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4828 | |
| 4829 | <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will |
| 4830 | be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client |
| 4831 | connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+" |
| 4832 | or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by |
| 4833 | adding this value to the client's port. |
| 4834 | |
| 4835 | <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords |
| 4836 | accepts an important number of options and has a complete section |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4837 | dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details. |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4838 | |
| 4839 | Examples : |
| 4840 | server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000 |
| 4841 | server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000 |
| 4842 | |
Mark Lamourine | c2247f0 | 2012-01-04 13:02:01 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4843 | See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about |
| 4844 | server options |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4845 | |
| 4846 | |
| 4847 | source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ] |
Willy Tarreau | bce7088 | 2009-09-07 11:51:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4848 | source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ] |
Willy Tarreau | d53f96b | 2009-02-04 18:46:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4849 | source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>] |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4850 | Set the source address for outgoing connections |
| 4851 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4852 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 4853 | Arguments : |
| 4854 | <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a |
| 4855 | server. This address is also used as a source for health checks. |
| 4856 | The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select |
| 4857 | the most appropriate address to reach its destination. |
| 4858 | |
| 4859 | <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful |
| 4860 | in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means |
Willy Tarreau | c6f4ce8 | 2009-06-10 11:09:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4861 | the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not |
| 4862 | supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you |
| 4863 | have to specify them on each "server" line. |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4864 | |
| 4865 | <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are |
| 4866 | forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only |
| 4867 | supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is |
| 4868 | specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented |
| 4869 | with this address, while health checks will still use the address |
| 4870 | <addr>. |
| 4871 | |
| 4872 | <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections |
| 4873 | are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above). |
| 4874 | The default value of zero means the system will select a free |
| 4875 | port. |
| 4876 | |
Willy Tarreau | bce7088 | 2009-09-07 11:51:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4877 | <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to. |
| 4878 | This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can |
| 4879 | contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is |
| 4880 | used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header |
| 4881 | and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen |
| 4882 | by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another |
| 4883 | occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter |
| 4884 | below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding |
| 4885 | is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also |
| 4886 | keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any |
| 4887 | HTTP header. |
| 4888 | |
| 4889 | <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value |
| 4890 | header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)", |
| 4891 | in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP |
| 4892 | address. Positive values indicate a position from the first |
| 4893 | occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate |
| 4894 | positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This |
| 4895 | is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set |
| 4896 | at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several |
| 4897 | proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is |
| 4898 | assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature. |
| 4899 | |
Willy Tarreau | d53f96b | 2009-02-04 18:46:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4900 | <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing |
| 4901 | traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only |
| 4902 | Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to |
| 4903 | this interface even if it is not the one the system would select |
| 4904 | based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care. |
| 4905 | Note that using this option requires root privileges. |
| 4906 | |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4907 | The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific |
| 4908 | address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a |
| 4909 | private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is |
| 4910 | known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself. |
| 4911 | |
| 4912 | An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used |
| 4913 | through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the |
| 4914 | servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This |
| 4915 | is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination |
| 4916 | servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine |
| 4917 | running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine. |
| 4918 | |
| 4919 | In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP |
| 4920 | address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more |
| 4921 | common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this, |
| 4922 | there are two methods : |
| 4923 | |
| 4924 | - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent |
| 4925 | mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on |
| 4926 | the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different |
| 4927 | states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not |
| 4928 | limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all |
| 4929 | of the client ranges may be used. |
| 4930 | |
| 4931 | - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This |
| 4932 | solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream |
| 4933 | firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside |
| 4934 | of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports. |
| 4935 | However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP |
| 4936 | connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the |
| 4937 | same session. |
| 4938 | |
| 4939 | Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be |
| 4940 | required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an |
| 4941 | IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the |
| 4942 | IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing |
| 4943 | address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure |
| 4944 | forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation. |
| 4945 | |
| 4946 | This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may |
| 4947 | also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification |
| 4948 | is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4949 | section 5 for more information. |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4950 | |
| 4951 | Examples : |
| 4952 | backend private |
| 4953 | # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address |
| 4954 | source 192.168.1.200 |
| 4955 | |
| 4956 | backend transparent_ssl1 |
| 4957 | # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address |
| 4958 | source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip |
| 4959 | |
| 4960 | backend transparent_ssl2 |
| 4961 | # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port |
| 4962 | # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine. |
| 4963 | source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client |
| 4964 | |
| 4965 | backend transparent_ssl3 |
| 4966 | # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It |
| 4967 | # is more conntrack-friendly. |
| 4968 | source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip |
| 4969 | |
| 4970 | backend transparent_smtp |
| 4971 | # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port |
| 4972 | # with Tproxy version 4. |
| 4973 | source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip |
| 4974 | |
Willy Tarreau | bce7088 | 2009-09-07 11:51:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4975 | backend transparent_http |
| 4976 | # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous |
| 4977 | # proxy. |
| 4978 | source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1) |
| 4979 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4980 | See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4981 | the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword. |
| 4982 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 25b501a | 2008-01-06 16:36:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4983 | |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4984 | srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated) |
| 4985 | Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side. |
| 4986 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4987 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 4988 | Arguments : |
| 4989 | <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but |
| 4990 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 4991 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 4992 | |
| 4993 | The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or |
| 4994 | send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider |
| 4995 | during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the |
| 4996 | headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the |
| 4997 | request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with |
| 4998 | what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs |
| 4999 | to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly. |
| 5000 | |
| 5001 | The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other |
| 5002 | unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this |
| 5003 | document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly |
| 5004 | recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in |
| 5005 | order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5006 | response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5007 | packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5008 | seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5009 | |
| 5010 | This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in |
| 5011 | "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to |
| 5012 | forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which |
| 5013 | is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning |
| 5014 | during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in |
| 5015 | the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either. |
| 5016 | |
| 5017 | This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated. |
| 5018 | Please use "timeout server" instead. |
| 5019 | |
Willy Tarreau | ce887fd | 2012-05-12 12:50:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5020 | See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and |
| 5021 | "clitimeout". |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5022 | |
| 5023 | |
Cyril Bonté | 66c327d | 2010-10-12 00:14:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5024 | stats admin { if | unless } <cond> |
| 5025 | Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched |
| 5026 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5027 | no | no | yes | yes |
| 5028 | |
| 5029 | This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is |
| 5030 | matched. |
| 5031 | |
| 5032 | The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By |
| 5033 | default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons. |
| 5034 | |
Cyril Bonté | 02ff8ef | 2010-12-14 22:48:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5035 | Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1) |
| 5036 | unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the |
| 5037 | processes, which can result in random behaviours. |
| 5038 | |
Cyril Bonté | 23b39d9 | 2011-02-10 22:54:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5039 | Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved |
| 5040 | buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the |
| 5041 | request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a |
| 5042 | time. |
Cyril Bonté | 66c327d | 2010-10-12 00:14:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5043 | |
| 5044 | Example : |
| 5045 | # statistics admin level only for localhost |
| 5046 | backend stats_localhost |
| 5047 | stats enable |
| 5048 | stats admin if LOCALHOST |
| 5049 | |
| 5050 | Example : |
| 5051 | # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication |
| 5052 | backend stats_auth |
| 5053 | stats enable |
| 5054 | stats auth admin:AdMiN123 |
| 5055 | stats admin if TRUE |
| 5056 | |
| 5057 | Example : |
| 5058 | # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user |
| 5059 | userlist stats-auth |
| 5060 | group admin users admin |
| 5061 | user admin insecure-password AdMiN123 |
| 5062 | group readonly users haproxy |
| 5063 | user haproxy insecure-password haproxy |
| 5064 | |
| 5065 | backend stats_auth |
| 5066 | stats enable |
| 5067 | acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth) |
| 5068 | acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin |
| 5069 | stats http-request auth unless AUTH |
| 5070 | stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN |
| 5071 | |
Cyril Bonté | 02ff8ef | 2010-12-14 22:48:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5072 | See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc", |
| 5073 | "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about |
| 5074 | ACL usage. |
Cyril Bonté | 66c327d | 2010-10-12 00:14:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5075 | |
| 5076 | |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5077 | stats auth <user>:<passwd> |
| 5078 | Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account |
| 5079 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5080 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 5081 | Arguments : |
| 5082 | <user> is a user name to grant access to |
| 5083 | |
| 5084 | <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user |
| 5085 | |
| 5086 | This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access |
| 5087 | to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to |
| 5088 | allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics |
| 5089 | without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that |
| 5090 | the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real |
| 5091 | which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm". |
| 5092 | |
| 5093 | Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords |
| 5094 | circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the |
| 5095 | configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users |
Willy Tarreau | 3c92c5f | 2011-08-28 09:45:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5096 | that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account. |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5097 | |
| 5098 | It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the |
| 5099 | report using "stats scope". |
| 5100 | |
| 5101 | Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is |
| 5102 | recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default |
| 5103 | unobvious parameters. |
| 5104 | |
| 5105 | Example : |
| 5106 | # public access (limited to this backend only) |
| 5107 | backend public_www |
| 5108 | server srv1 192.168.0.1:80 |
| 5109 | stats enable |
| 5110 | stats hide-version |
| 5111 | stats scope . |
| 5112 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5113 | stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics |
| 5114 | stats auth admin1:AdMiN123 |
| 5115 | stats auth admin2:AdMiN321 |
| 5116 | |
| 5117 | # internal monitoring access (unlimited) |
| 5118 | backend private_monitoring |
| 5119 | stats enable |
| 5120 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5121 | stats refresh 5s |
| 5122 | |
| 5123 | See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri" |
| 5124 | |
| 5125 | |
| 5126 | stats enable |
| 5127 | Enable statistics reporting with default settings |
| 5128 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5129 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 5130 | Arguments : none |
| 5131 | |
| 5132 | This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined |
| 5133 | at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used : |
| 5134 | - stats uri : /haproxy?stats |
| 5135 | - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics" |
| 5136 | - stats auth : no authentication |
| 5137 | - stats scope : no restriction |
| 5138 | |
| 5139 | Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is |
| 5140 | recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default |
| 5141 | unobvious parameters. |
| 5142 | |
| 5143 | Example : |
| 5144 | # public access (limited to this backend only) |
| 5145 | backend public_www |
| 5146 | server srv1 192.168.0.1:80 |
| 5147 | stats enable |
| 5148 | stats hide-version |
| 5149 | stats scope . |
| 5150 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5151 | stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics |
| 5152 | stats auth admin1:AdMiN123 |
| 5153 | stats auth admin2:AdMiN321 |
| 5154 | |
| 5155 | # internal monitoring access (unlimited) |
| 5156 | backend private_monitoring |
| 5157 | stats enable |
| 5158 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5159 | stats refresh 5s |
| 5160 | |
| 5161 | See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri" |
| 5162 | |
| 5163 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5164 | stats hide-version |
| 5165 | Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting |
Willy Tarreau | 1d45b7c | 2009-08-16 10:29:18 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5166 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5167 | yes | no | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5168 | Arguments : none |
Willy Tarreau | 1d45b7c | 2009-08-16 10:29:18 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5169 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5170 | By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with |
| 5171 | the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally |
| 5172 | considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them |
| 5173 | target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version" |
| 5174 | statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended |
| 5175 | for public sites or any site with a weak login/password. |
Willy Tarreau | 1d45b7c | 2009-08-16 10:29:18 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5176 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 48cb2ae | 2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5177 | Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is |
| 5178 | recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default |
| 5179 | unobvious parameters. |
| 5180 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5181 | Example : |
| 5182 | # public access (limited to this backend only) |
| 5183 | backend public_www |
| 5184 | server srv1 192.168.0.1:80 |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 48cb2ae | 2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5185 | stats enable |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5186 | stats hide-version |
| 5187 | stats scope . |
| 5188 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5189 | stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics |
| 5190 | stats auth admin1:AdMiN123 |
| 5191 | stats auth admin2:AdMiN321 |
Willy Tarreau | 1d45b7c | 2009-08-16 10:29:18 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5192 | |
Willy Tarreau | 1d45b7c | 2009-08-16 10:29:18 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5193 | # internal monitoring access (unlimited) |
| 5194 | backend private_monitoring |
| 5195 | stats enable |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5196 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5197 | stats refresh 5s |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 15514c2 | 2010-01-04 16:03:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5198 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5199 | See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri" |
Willy Tarreau | 1d45b7c | 2009-08-16 10:29:18 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5200 | |
Willy Tarreau | 983e01e | 2010-01-11 18:42:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5201 | |
Cyril Bonté | 2be1b3f | 2010-09-30 23:46:30 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5202 | stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] } |
| 5203 | [ { if | unless } <condition> ] |
| 5204 | Access control for statistics |
| 5205 | |
| 5206 | May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5207 | no | no | yes | yes |
| 5208 | |
| 5209 | As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to |
| 5210 | statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl. |
| 5211 | First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final. |
| 5212 | For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is |
| 5213 | performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client |
| 5214 | should be asked to enter a username and password. |
| 5215 | |
| 5216 | There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per |
| 5217 | instance. |
| 5218 | |
| 5219 | See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 |
| 5220 | about ACL usage. |
| 5221 | |
| 5222 | |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5223 | stats realm <realm> |
| 5224 | Enable statistics and set authentication realm |
| 5225 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5226 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 5227 | Arguments : |
| 5228 | <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to |
| 5229 | the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up |
| 5230 | inviting the user to enter a valid username and password. |
| 5231 | |
| 5232 | The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped |
| 5233 | using a backslash ('\'). |
| 5234 | |
| 5235 | This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is |
| 5236 | only related to authentication. |
| 5237 | |
| 5238 | Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is |
| 5239 | recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default |
| 5240 | unobvious parameters. |
| 5241 | |
| 5242 | Example : |
| 5243 | # public access (limited to this backend only) |
| 5244 | backend public_www |
| 5245 | server srv1 192.168.0.1:80 |
| 5246 | stats enable |
| 5247 | stats hide-version |
| 5248 | stats scope . |
| 5249 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5250 | stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics |
| 5251 | stats auth admin1:AdMiN123 |
| 5252 | stats auth admin2:AdMiN321 |
| 5253 | |
| 5254 | # internal monitoring access (unlimited) |
| 5255 | backend private_monitoring |
| 5256 | stats enable |
| 5257 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5258 | stats refresh 5s |
| 5259 | |
| 5260 | See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri" |
| 5261 | |
| 5262 | |
| 5263 | stats refresh <delay> |
| 5264 | Enable statistics with automatic refresh |
| 5265 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5266 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 5267 | Arguments : |
| 5268 | <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will |
| 5269 | be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the |
| 5270 | browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it |
| 5271 | and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may |
| 5272 | be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the |
| 5273 | unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document. |
| 5274 | |
| 5275 | This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page |
| 5276 | reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will |
| 5277 | include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether |
| 5278 | he wants automatic refresh of the page or not. |
| 5279 | |
| 5280 | Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is |
| 5281 | recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default |
| 5282 | unobvious parameters. |
| 5283 | |
| 5284 | Example : |
| 5285 | # public access (limited to this backend only) |
| 5286 | backend public_www |
| 5287 | server srv1 192.168.0.1:80 |
| 5288 | stats enable |
| 5289 | stats hide-version |
| 5290 | stats scope . |
| 5291 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5292 | stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics |
| 5293 | stats auth admin1:AdMiN123 |
| 5294 | stats auth admin2:AdMiN321 |
| 5295 | |
| 5296 | # internal monitoring access (unlimited) |
| 5297 | backend private_monitoring |
| 5298 | stats enable |
| 5299 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5300 | stats refresh 5s |
| 5301 | |
| 5302 | See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri" |
| 5303 | |
| 5304 | |
| 5305 | stats scope { <name> | "." } |
| 5306 | Enable statistics and limit access scope |
| 5307 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5308 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 5309 | Arguments : |
| 5310 | <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be |
| 5311 | reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the |
| 5312 | section in which the statement appears. |
| 5313 | |
| 5314 | When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this |
| 5315 | statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This |
| 5316 | statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be |
| 5317 | reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string |
| 5318 | comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really |
| 5319 | exists. |
| 5320 | |
| 5321 | Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is |
| 5322 | recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default |
| 5323 | unobvious parameters. |
| 5324 | |
| 5325 | Example : |
| 5326 | # public access (limited to this backend only) |
| 5327 | backend public_www |
| 5328 | server srv1 192.168.0.1:80 |
| 5329 | stats enable |
| 5330 | stats hide-version |
| 5331 | stats scope . |
| 5332 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5333 | stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics |
| 5334 | stats auth admin1:AdMiN123 |
| 5335 | stats auth admin2:AdMiN321 |
| 5336 | |
| 5337 | # internal monitoring access (unlimited) |
| 5338 | backend private_monitoring |
| 5339 | stats enable |
| 5340 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5341 | stats refresh 5s |
| 5342 | |
| 5343 | See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri" |
| 5344 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5345 | |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5346 | stats show-desc [ <desc> ] |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5347 | Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page. |
| 5348 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5349 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 5350 | |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5351 | <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5352 | description from global section is automatically used instead. |
| 5353 | |
| 5354 | This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their |
| 5355 | customers, where node or description should be different for each customer. |
| 5356 | |
| 5357 | Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is |
| 5358 | recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default |
Dmitry Sivachenko | 7823de3 | 2012-05-16 14:00:26 +0400 | [diff] [blame] | 5359 | unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown. |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5360 | |
| 5361 | Example : |
| 5362 | # internal monitoring access (unlimited) |
| 5363 | backend private_monitoring |
| 5364 | stats enable |
| 5365 | stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa |
| 5366 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5367 | stats refresh 5s |
| 5368 | |
| 5369 | See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in |
| 5370 | global section. |
| 5371 | |
| 5372 | |
| 5373 | stats show-legends |
| 5374 | Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page : |
| 5375 | - cap: capabilities (proxy) |
| 5376 | - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy) |
| 5377 | - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server) |
| 5378 | - IP (socket, server) |
| 5379 | - cookie (backend, server) |
| 5380 | |
| 5381 | Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is |
| 5382 | recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default |
Dmitry Sivachenko | 7823de3 | 2012-05-16 14:00:26 +0400 | [diff] [blame] | 5383 | unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information. |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5384 | |
| 5385 | See also: "stats enable", "stats uri". |
| 5386 | |
| 5387 | |
| 5388 | stats show-node [ <name> ] |
| 5389 | Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page. |
| 5390 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5391 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 5392 | Arguments: |
| 5393 | <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the |
| 5394 | node name from global section is automatically used instead. |
| 5395 | |
| 5396 | This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their |
| 5397 | customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page |
Dmitry Sivachenko | 7823de3 | 2012-05-16 14:00:26 +0400 | [diff] [blame] | 5398 | provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name. |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5399 | |
| 5400 | Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is |
| 5401 | recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default |
| 5402 | unobvious parameters. |
| 5403 | |
| 5404 | Example: |
| 5405 | # internal monitoring access (unlimited) |
| 5406 | backend private_monitoring |
| 5407 | stats enable |
| 5408 | stats show-node Europe-1 |
| 5409 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5410 | stats refresh 5s |
| 5411 | |
| 5412 | See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global |
| 5413 | section. |
| 5414 | |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5415 | |
| 5416 | stats uri <prefix> |
| 5417 | Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them |
| 5418 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5419 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 5420 | Arguments : |
| 5421 | <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This |
| 5422 | prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a |
| 5423 | query string. |
| 5424 | |
| 5425 | The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a |
| 5426 | page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the |
| 5427 | selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be |
| 5428 | possible to reach it in the application. |
| 5429 | |
| 5430 | The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5431 | changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here. |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5432 | It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that |
| 5433 | intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string |
| 5434 | beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question |
| 5435 | mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words. |
| 5436 | |
| 5437 | It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that |
| 5438 | statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate |
| 5439 | an address or a port to statistics only. |
| 5440 | |
| 5441 | Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is |
| 5442 | recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default |
| 5443 | unobvious parameters. |
| 5444 | |
| 5445 | Example : |
| 5446 | # public access (limited to this backend only) |
| 5447 | backend public_www |
| 5448 | server srv1 192.168.0.1:80 |
| 5449 | stats enable |
| 5450 | stats hide-version |
| 5451 | stats scope . |
| 5452 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5453 | stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics |
| 5454 | stats auth admin1:AdMiN123 |
| 5455 | stats auth admin2:AdMiN321 |
| 5456 | |
| 5457 | # internal monitoring access (unlimited) |
| 5458 | backend private_monitoring |
| 5459 | stats enable |
| 5460 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5461 | stats refresh 5s |
| 5462 | |
| 5463 | See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm" |
| 5464 | |
| 5465 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5466 | stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>] |
| 5467 | Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5468 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5469 | no | no | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5470 | |
| 5471 | Arguments : |
| 5472 | <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It |
| 5473 | describes what elements of the incoming request or connection |
| 5474 | will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a |
| 5475 | stickiness table. This rule is mandatory. |
| 5476 | |
| 5477 | <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same |
| 5478 | backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using |
| 5479 | the "stick-table" statement. |
| 5480 | |
| 5481 | <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match |
| 5482 | on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or |
| 5483 | not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP |
| 5484 | address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in |
| 5485 | which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address. |
| 5486 | |
| 5487 | Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot |
| 5488 | always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement |
| 5489 | describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request |
| 5490 | or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and |
| 5491 | transformation rules. |
| 5492 | |
| 5493 | The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of |
| 5494 | a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present |
| 5495 | in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by |
| 5496 | referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced, |
| 5497 | the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs |
| 5498 | start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of |
| 5499 | doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting. |
| 5500 | |
| 5501 | It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement |
| 5502 | will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for |
| 5503 | ACL based conditions. |
| 5504 | |
| 5505 | There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that |
| 5506 | applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server |
| 5507 | as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple |
| 5508 | matches can be used as fallbacks. |
| 5509 | |
| 5510 | The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not |
| 5511 | affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That |
| 5512 | way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in |
| 5513 | order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS. |
| 5514 | |
Cyril Bonté | 02ff8ef | 2010-12-14 22:48:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5515 | Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1) |
| 5516 | unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the |
| 5517 | processes, which can result in random behaviours. |
| 5518 | |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5519 | Example : |
| 5520 | # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the |
| 5521 | # last 30 minutes |
| 5522 | backend pop |
| 5523 | mode tcp |
| 5524 | balance roundrobin |
| 5525 | stick store-request src |
| 5526 | stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m |
| 5527 | server s1 192.168.1.1:110 |
| 5528 | server s2 192.168.1.1:110 |
| 5529 | |
| 5530 | backend smtp |
| 5531 | mode tcp |
| 5532 | balance roundrobin |
| 5533 | stick match src table pop |
| 5534 | server s1 192.168.1.1:25 |
| 5535 | server s2 192.168.1.1:25 |
| 5536 | |
Cyril Bonté | 02ff8ef | 2010-12-14 22:48:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5537 | See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7 |
| 5538 | about ACLs and pattern extraction. |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5539 | |
| 5540 | |
| 5541 | stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>] |
| 5542 | Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server |
| 5543 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5544 | no | no | yes | yes |
| 5545 | |
| 5546 | Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by |
| 5547 | "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer |
| 5548 | to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience |
| 5549 | for writing more maintainable configurations. |
| 5550 | |
Cyril Bonté | 02ff8ef | 2010-12-14 22:48:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5551 | Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1) |
| 5552 | unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the |
| 5553 | processes, which can result in random behaviours. |
| 5554 | |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5555 | Examples : |
| 5556 | # The following form ... |
Willy Tarreau | ec579d8 | 2010-02-26 19:15:04 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5557 | stick on src table pop if !localhost |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5558 | |
| 5559 | # ...is strictly equivalent to this one : |
| 5560 | stick match src table pop if !localhost |
| 5561 | stick store-request src table pop if !localhost |
| 5562 | |
| 5563 | |
| 5564 | # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as |
| 5565 | # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses. |
| 5566 | backend http |
| 5567 | mode http |
| 5568 | balance roundrobin |
| 5569 | stick on src table https |
| 5570 | cookie SRV insert indirect nocache |
| 5571 | server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1 |
| 5572 | server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2 |
| 5573 | |
| 5574 | backend https |
| 5575 | mode tcp |
| 5576 | balance roundrobin |
| 5577 | stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m |
| 5578 | stick on src |
| 5579 | server s1 192.168.1.1:443 |
| 5580 | server s2 192.168.1.1:443 |
| 5581 | |
Cyril Bonté | 02ff8ef | 2010-12-14 22:48:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5582 | See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process". |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5583 | |
| 5584 | |
| 5585 | stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>] |
| 5586 | Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table |
| 5587 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5588 | no | no | yes | yes |
| 5589 | |
| 5590 | Arguments : |
| 5591 | <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It |
| 5592 | describes what elements of the incoming request or connection |
| 5593 | will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a |
| 5594 | server is selected. |
| 5595 | |
| 5596 | <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same |
| 5597 | backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using |
| 5598 | the "stick-table" statement. |
| 5599 | |
| 5600 | <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store |
| 5601 | certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met). |
| 5602 | For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address |
| 5603 | except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which |
| 5604 | case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP |
| 5605 | address. |
| 5606 | |
| 5607 | Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot |
| 5608 | always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement |
| 5609 | describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do |
| 5610 | it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to |
| 5611 | match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must |
| 5612 | make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a |
| 5613 | client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a |
| 5614 | URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make |
| 5615 | any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete |
| 5616 | list of possible patterns and transformation rules. |
| 5617 | |
| 5618 | The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of |
| 5619 | a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present |
| 5620 | in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by |
| 5621 | referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced, |
| 5622 | the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs |
| 5623 | start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of |
| 5624 | doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting. |
| 5625 | |
| 5626 | It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request" |
| 5627 | statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This |
| 5628 | condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be |
| 5629 | used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions. |
| 5630 | |
| 5631 | There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but |
| 5632 | there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This |
| 5633 | makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the |
| 5634 | request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first |
| 5635 | ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple |
| 5636 | tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on |
| 5637 | another protocol or access method. |
| 5638 | |
| 5639 | The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been |
| 5640 | established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed |
| 5641 | the request. |
| 5642 | |
Cyril Bonté | 02ff8ef | 2010-12-14 22:48:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5643 | Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1) |
| 5644 | unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the |
| 5645 | processes, which can result in random behaviours. |
| 5646 | |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5647 | Example : |
| 5648 | # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the |
| 5649 | # last 30 minutes |
| 5650 | backend pop |
| 5651 | mode tcp |
| 5652 | balance roundrobin |
| 5653 | stick store-request src |
| 5654 | stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m |
| 5655 | server s1 192.168.1.1:110 |
| 5656 | server s2 192.168.1.1:110 |
| 5657 | |
| 5658 | backend smtp |
| 5659 | mode tcp |
| 5660 | balance roundrobin |
| 5661 | stick match src table pop |
| 5662 | server s1 192.168.1.1:25 |
| 5663 | server s2 192.168.1.1:25 |
| 5664 | |
Cyril Bonté | 02ff8ef | 2010-12-14 22:48:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5665 | See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7 |
| 5666 | about ACLs and pattern extraction. |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5667 | |
| 5668 | |
Emeric Brun | 7c6b82e | 2010-09-24 16:34:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5669 | stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]} |
Emeric Brun | f099e79 | 2010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5670 | size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] |
| 5671 | [store <data_type>]* |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5672 | Configure the stickiness table for the current backend |
| 5673 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
Willy Tarreau | c00cdc2 | 2010-06-06 16:48:26 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5674 | no | yes | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5675 | |
| 5676 | Arguments : |
| 5677 | ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses. |
| 5678 | This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows |
| 5679 | very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This |
| 5680 | is mainly used to store client source IP addresses. |
| 5681 | |
David du Colombier | 9a6d3c9 | 2011-03-17 10:40:24 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5682 | ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses. |
| 5683 | This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows |
| 5684 | very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This |
| 5685 | is mainly used to store client source IP addresses. |
| 5686 | |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5687 | integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers |
| 5688 | which can represent a client identifier found in a request for |
| 5689 | instance. |
| 5690 | |
| 5691 | string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up |
| 5692 | to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern |
| 5693 | extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before |
| 5694 | being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be |
| 5695 | compared between the string in the table and the extracted |
| 5696 | pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited |
Emeric Brun | 7c6b82e | 2010-09-24 16:34:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5697 | to 32 characters. |
| 5698 | |
| 5699 | binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks |
| 5700 | of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern |
| 5701 | extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before |
| 5702 | being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor |
| 5703 | is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not |
| 5704 | specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes. |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5705 | |
| 5706 | <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a |
Emeric Brun | 7c6b82e | 2010-09-24 16:34:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5707 | "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number |
| 5708 | of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5709 | changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally |
| 5710 | increase. |
| 5711 | |
| 5712 | <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This |
Cyril Bonté | 78caf84 | 2010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5713 | value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately |
| 5714 | 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size |
| 5715 | supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors. |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5716 | |
| 5717 | [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table |
| 5718 | is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy |
| 5719 | wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest |
| 5720 | entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is |
| 5721 | most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it |
| 5722 | be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older |
| 5723 | ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is |
| 5724 | far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access |
| 5725 | to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When |
| 5726 | using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire" |
| 5727 | parameter (see below). |
| 5728 | |
Emeric Brun | f099e79 | 2010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5729 | <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries |
| 5730 | which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with |
| 5731 | the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also |
| 5732 | automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a |
| 5733 | soft restart. |
| 5734 | |
Cyril Bonté | 02ff8ef | 2010-12-14 22:48:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5735 | NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode. |
| 5736 | |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5737 | <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it |
| 5738 | was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is |
| 5739 | defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various |
| 5740 | timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See |
| 5741 | section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified, |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5742 | the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5743 | be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter |
| 5744 | if not expiration delay is specified. |
| 5745 | |
Willy Tarreau | 08d5f98 | 2010-06-06 13:34:54 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5746 | <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This |
| 5747 | may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related |
| 5748 | to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each |
| 5749 | item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5750 | that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be |
| 5751 | stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after |
| 5752 | the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively, |
| 5753 | it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or |
| 5754 | several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is |
| 5755 | automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be |
| 5756 | explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data |
| 5757 | type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some |
| 5758 | data types require an argument which must be passed just after |
| 5759 | the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data |
| 5760 | types and their arguments. |
| 5761 | |
| 5762 | The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following : |
| 5763 | - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a |
| 5764 | request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store", |
| 5765 | and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced. |
| 5766 | |
| 5767 | - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer |
| 5768 | integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used |
| 5769 | to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a |
| 5770 | specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches. |
| 5771 | |
| 5772 | - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts |
| 5773 | the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched |
| 5774 | this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that |
| 5775 | they were received. |
| 5776 | |
| 5777 | - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which |
| 5778 | stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented |
| 5779 | once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the |
| 5780 | connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact |
| 5781 | number of concurrent connections for an entry. |
| 5782 | |
| 5783 | - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an |
| 5784 | integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length |
| 5785 | of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average |
| 5786 | incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The |
| 5787 | result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs. |
| 5788 | |
| 5789 | - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts |
| 5790 | the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this |
| 5791 | entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules. |
| 5792 | |
| 5793 | - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an |
| 5794 | integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length |
| 5795 | of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average |
| 5796 | incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The |
| 5797 | result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs. |
| 5798 | |
| 5799 | - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which |
| 5800 | counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which |
| 5801 | matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or |
| 5802 | not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on |
| 5803 | the client side. |
| 5804 | |
| 5805 | - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an |
| 5806 | integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length |
| 5807 | of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average |
| 5808 | HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is |
| 5809 | an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether |
| 5810 | they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions |
| 5811 | when keep-alive is used on the client side. |
| 5812 | |
| 5813 | - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which |
| 5814 | counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients |
| 5815 | which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated |
| 5816 | requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed |
| 5817 | authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is |
| 5818 | also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client |
| 5819 | (eg: vulnerability scan). |
| 5820 | |
| 5821 | - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an |
| 5822 | integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length |
| 5823 | of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average |
| 5824 | HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see |
| 5825 | http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an |
| 5826 | integer which can be matched using ACLs. |
| 5827 | |
| 5828 | - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit |
| 5829 | integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients |
| 5830 | which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be |
| 5831 | used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers. |
| 5832 | |
| 5833 | - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an |
| 5834 | integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length |
| 5835 | of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average |
| 5836 | incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used |
| 5837 | to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large |
| 5838 | uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted |
| 5839 | once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed |
| 5840 | instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with |
| 5841 | "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is |
| 5842 | recommended for better fairness. |
| 5843 | |
| 5844 | - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit |
| 5845 | integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which |
| 5846 | matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used |
| 5847 | to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site. |
| 5848 | |
| 5849 | - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes |
| 5850 | an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length |
| 5851 | of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average |
| 5852 | outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used |
| 5853 | to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large |
| 5854 | transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be |
| 5855 | counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average |
| 5856 | transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be |
| 5857 | smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of |
| 5858 | byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness. |
Willy Tarreau | 08d5f98 | 2010-06-06 13:34:54 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5859 | |
Willy Tarreau | c00cdc2 | 2010-06-06 16:48:26 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5860 | There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc, |
| 5861 | it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5862 | to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and |
| 5863 | reference it. |
| 5864 | |
| 5865 | It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information |
| 5866 | has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are |
| 5867 | lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always |
| 5868 | as an exclusive stickiness. |
| 5869 | |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5870 | Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types. |
| 5871 | Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes |
| 5872 | per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not |
| 5873 | something that can be ignored. |
| 5874 | |
| 5875 | Example: |
| 5876 | # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes |
| 5877 | # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate |
| 5878 | # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds. |
| 5879 | stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s) |
| 5880 | |
| 5881 | See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2 |
David du Colombier | a13d1b9 | 2011-03-17 10:40:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5882 | about time format and section 7 about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5883 | |
| 5884 | |
Emeric Brun | 6a1cefa | 2010-09-24 18:15:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5885 | stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>] |
| 5886 | Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table |
| 5887 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5888 | no | no | yes | yes |
| 5889 | |
| 5890 | Arguments : |
| 5891 | <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It |
| 5892 | describes what elements of the response or connection will |
| 5893 | be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a |
| 5894 | server is selected. |
| 5895 | |
| 5896 | <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same |
| 5897 | backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using |
| 5898 | the "stick-table" statement. |
| 5899 | |
| 5900 | <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store |
| 5901 | certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met). |
| 5902 | For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only |
| 5903 | when the response is a SSL server hello. |
| 5904 | |
| 5905 | Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot |
| 5906 | always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response" |
| 5907 | statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and |
| 5908 | when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further |
| 5909 | requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the |
| 5910 | extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5911 | request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense. |
Emeric Brun | 6a1cefa | 2010-09-24 18:15:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5912 | See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation |
| 5913 | rules. |
| 5914 | |
| 5915 | The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of |
| 5916 | a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present |
| 5917 | in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by |
| 5918 | referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced, |
| 5919 | the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs |
| 5920 | start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of |
| 5921 | doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting. |
| 5922 | |
| 5923 | It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response" |
| 5924 | statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This |
| 5925 | condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can |
| 5926 | be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions. |
| 5927 | |
| 5928 | There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but |
| 5929 | there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This |
| 5930 | makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the |
| 5931 | request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first |
| 5932 | ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple |
| 5933 | tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on |
| 5934 | another protocol or access method. |
| 5935 | |
| 5936 | The table will contain the real server that processed the request. |
| 5937 | |
| 5938 | Example : |
| 5939 | # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity. |
| 5940 | backend https |
| 5941 | mode tcp |
| 5942 | balance roundrobin |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5943 | # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes. |
Emeric Brun | 6a1cefa | 2010-09-24 18:15:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5944 | stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5945 | |
Emeric Brun | 6a1cefa | 2010-09-24 18:15:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5946 | acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1 |
| 5947 | acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2 |
| 5948 | |
| 5949 | # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello. |
| 5950 | tcp-request inspect-delay 5s |
| 5951 | tcp-request content accept if clienthello |
| 5952 | |
| 5953 | # no timeout on response inspect delay by default. |
| 5954 | tcp-response content accept if serverhello |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5955 | |
Emeric Brun | 6a1cefa | 2010-09-24 18:15:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5956 | # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello. |
| 5957 | # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts |
| 5958 | # at offset 44. |
| 5959 | |
| 5960 | # Match and learn on request if client hello. |
| 5961 | stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello |
| 5962 | |
| 5963 | # Learn on response if server hello. |
| 5964 | stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5965 | |
Emeric Brun | 6a1cefa | 2010-09-24 18:15:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5966 | server s1 192.168.1.1:443 |
| 5967 | server s2 192.168.1.1:443 |
| 5968 | |
| 5969 | See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern |
| 5970 | extraction. |
| 5971 | |
| 5972 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5973 | tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>] |
| 5974 | Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition |
Willy Tarreau | 1a68794 | 2010-05-23 22:40:30 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5975 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5976 | no | yes | yes | no |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5977 | Arguments : |
| 5978 | <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid |
| 5979 | actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2". |
| 5980 | See below for more details. |
Willy Tarreau | 1a68794 | 2010-05-23 22:40:30 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5981 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5982 | <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7). |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5983 | |
| 5984 | Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to |
| 5985 | evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5986 | or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of |
| 5987 | any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the |
| 5988 | buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly |
| 5989 | accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If |
| 5990 | some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the |
| 5991 | "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead. |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5992 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5993 | The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration |
| 5994 | order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to |
| 5995 | accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of |
| 5996 | rules which may be inserted. |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5997 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5998 | Three types of actions are supported : |
| 5999 | - accept : |
| 6000 | accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if") |
| 6001 | or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends |
| 6002 | the rules evaluation. |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6003 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6004 | - reject : |
| 6005 | rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if") |
| 6006 | or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends |
| 6007 | the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a |
| 6008 | session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats, |
| 6009 | as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session |
| 6010 | rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules |
| 6011 | should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as |
| 6012 | the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme |
| 6013 | conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the |
| 6014 | system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If |
| 6015 | logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should |
| 6016 | be used instead. |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6017 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6018 | - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] : |
| 6019 | enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These |
| 6020 | rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets |
| 6021 | of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The |
| 6022 | first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the |
| 6023 | specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed |
| 6024 | enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second |
| 6025 | set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for |
| 6026 | the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones. |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6027 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6028 | These actions take one or two arguments : |
| 6029 | <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will |
| 6030 | be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With |
| 6031 | it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address. |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6032 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6033 | <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, |
| 6034 | which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All |
| 6035 | the counters for the matches and updates for the key will |
| 6036 | then be performed in that table until the session ends. |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6037 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6038 | Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table |
| 6039 | and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to |
| 6040 | that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's |
| 6041 | counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's |
| 6042 | counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends. |
| 6043 | If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is |
| 6044 | counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not |
| 6045 | expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance |
| 6046 | advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is |
| 6047 | performed for all ACL checks that make use of it. |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6048 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6049 | Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on |
| 6050 | the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for |
| 6051 | "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject. |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6052 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6053 | Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast |
| 6054 | connection without counting them, and track accepted connections. |
| 6055 | This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources. |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6056 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6057 | tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst } |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6058 | tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 } |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6059 | tcp-request connection track-sc1 src |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6060 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6061 | Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other |
| 6062 | connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones |
| 6063 | being blocked as long as they don't slow down. |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6064 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6065 | tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst } |
| 6066 | tcp-request connection track-sc1 src |
| 6067 | tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 } |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6068 | |
| 6069 | See section 7 about ACL usage. |
| 6070 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6071 | See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table" |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6072 | |
| 6073 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6074 | tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>] |
| 6075 | Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6076 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
Willy Tarreau | fb35620 | 2010-08-03 14:02:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6077 | no | yes | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6078 | Arguments : |
| 6079 | <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid |
| 6080 | actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2". |
| 6081 | See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification. |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6082 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6083 | <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7). |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6084 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6085 | A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing |
| 6086 | called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are |
| 6087 | evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an |
| 6088 | "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay |
| 6089 | expires with no matching rule. |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6090 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6091 | The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules |
| 6092 | is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a |
| 6093 | decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or |
| 6094 | validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in |
| 6095 | both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new |
| 6096 | connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned |
| 6097 | a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated |
| 6098 | several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned |
| 6099 | (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request). |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6100 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6101 | Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no |
| 6102 | rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the |
| 6103 | contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be |
| 6104 | inserted. |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6105 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6106 | Three types of actions are supported : |
| 6107 | - accept : |
| 6108 | - reject : |
| 6109 | - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6110 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6111 | They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection" |
| 6112 | so please refer to that section for a complete description. |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6113 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6114 | Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule |
| 6115 | defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session |
| 6116 | releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case |
| 6117 | of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing |
| 6118 | mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track |
| 6119 | per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters. |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6120 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6121 | Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6122 | the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for |
| 6123 | "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject. |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6124 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6125 | It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content" |
Willy Tarreau | c0239e0 | 2012-04-16 14:42:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6126 | rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the |
| 6127 | contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered |
| 6128 | contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match. |
| 6129 | The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP |
| 6130 | processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6131 | |
| 6132 | Example: |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6133 | # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com" |
| 6134 | # and reject everything else. |
| 6135 | acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com |
| 6136 | tcp-request inspect-delay 30s |
Willy Tarreau | c0239e0 | 2012-04-16 14:42:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6137 | tcp-request content accept if is_host_com |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6138 | tcp-request content reject |
| 6139 | |
| 6140 | Example: |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6141 | # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first |
| 6142 | tcp-request inspect-delay 30s |
| 6143 | acl content_present req_len gt 0 |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6144 | tcp-request content reject if content_present |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6145 | |
| 6146 | # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks |
| 6147 | tcp-request inspect-delay 30s |
| 6148 | acl content_present req_len gt 0 |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6149 | tcp-request content accept if content_present |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6150 | tcp-request content reject |
| 6151 | |
| 6152 | Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the |
| 6153 | frontend when the backend detects abuse. |
| 6154 | |
| 6155 | frontend http |
| 6156 | # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter |
| 6157 | # protecting all our sites |
| 6158 | stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0 |
| 6159 | tcp-request connection track-sc1 src |
| 6160 | tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 } |
| 6161 | ... |
| 6162 | use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php } |
| 6163 | |
| 6164 | backend http_dynamic |
| 6165 | # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked |
| 6166 | # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend. |
| 6167 | stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s) |
| 6168 | acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10 |
| 6169 | acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0 |
| 6170 | tcp-request content track-sc2 src |
| 6171 | tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6172 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6173 | See section 7 about ACL usage. |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6174 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6175 | See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay" |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6176 | |
| 6177 | |
| 6178 | tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout> |
| 6179 | Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection |
| 6180 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
Willy Tarreau | fb35620 | 2010-08-03 14:02:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6181 | no | yes | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6182 | Arguments : |
| 6183 | <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but |
| 6184 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 6185 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 6186 | |
| 6187 | People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the |
| 6188 | risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In |
| 6189 | order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold |
| 6190 | the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of |
| 6191 | data for at most the specified amount of time. |
| 6192 | |
Willy Tarreau | fb35620 | 2010-08-03 14:02:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6193 | TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a |
| 6194 | frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This |
| 6195 | means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a |
| 6196 | second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules. |
| 6197 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6198 | Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole |
| 6199 | rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6200 | those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay, |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6201 | a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the |
Willy Tarreau | d869b24 | 2009-03-15 14:43:58 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6202 | contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all |
| 6203 | and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information. |
| 6204 | Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such |
| 6205 | setups are not recommended. |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6206 | |
| 6207 | As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If |
| 6208 | the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let |
| 6209 | it pass through unaffected. |
| 6210 | |
| 6211 | For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients |
| 6212 | send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to |
| 6213 | cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6214 | to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6215 | before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing |
| 6216 | data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at |
Willy Tarreau | b824b00 | 2010-09-29 16:36:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6217 | least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client |
| 6218 | closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires |
| 6219 | since the contents will not be able to change anymore. |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6220 | |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6221 | See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject", |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6222 | "timeout client". |
| 6223 | |
| 6224 | |
Emeric Brun | 0a3b67f | 2010-09-24 15:34:53 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6225 | tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>] |
| 6226 | Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition |
| 6227 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6228 | no | no | yes | yes |
| 6229 | Arguments : |
| 6230 | <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid |
| 6231 | actions include : "accept", "reject". |
| 6232 | See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification. |
| 6233 | |
| 6234 | <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7). |
| 6235 | |
| 6236 | Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing |
| 6237 | called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are |
| 6238 | evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an |
| 6239 | "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6240 | set and expires with no matching rule. |
Emeric Brun | 0a3b67f | 2010-09-24 15:34:53 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6241 | |
| 6242 | Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity. |
| 6243 | |
| 6244 | Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no |
| 6245 | rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the |
| 6246 | contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be |
| 6247 | inserted. |
| 6248 | |
| 6249 | Two types of actions are supported : |
| 6250 | - accept : |
| 6251 | accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if") |
| 6252 | or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends |
| 6253 | the rules evaluation. |
| 6254 | |
| 6255 | - reject : |
| 6256 | rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if") |
| 6257 | or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends |
| 6258 | the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediatly closed. |
| 6259 | |
| 6260 | Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on |
| 6261 | the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for |
| 6262 | for changing the default action to a reject. |
| 6263 | |
| 6264 | It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-reponse content" |
| 6265 | rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has been |
| 6266 | buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the |
| 6267 | best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection |
| 6268 | period. |
| 6269 | |
| 6270 | See section 7 about ACL usage. |
| 6271 | |
| 6272 | See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay" |
| 6273 | |
| 6274 | |
| 6275 | tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout> |
| 6276 | Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection |
| 6277 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6278 | no | no | yes | yes |
| 6279 | Arguments : |
| 6280 | <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but |
| 6281 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 6282 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 6283 | |
| 6284 | See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay". |
| 6285 | |
| 6286 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 5259dfe | 2008-01-21 01:54:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6287 | timeout check <timeout> |
| 6288 | Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already |
| 6289 | established. |
| 6290 | |
| 6291 | May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6292 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 6293 | Arguments: |
| 6294 | <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but |
| 6295 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 6296 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 6297 | |
| 6298 | If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout |
| 6299 | for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is |
| 6300 | used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those |
| 6301 | who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks. |
Willy Tarreau | d7550a2 | 2010-02-10 05:10:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6302 | (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect |
| 6303 | timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to |
| 6304 | avoid that). |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 5259dfe | 2008-01-21 01:54:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6305 | |
| 6306 | If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check |
| 6307 | timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version. |
| 6308 | |
| 6309 | In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal |
| 6310 | requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should |
Willy Tarreau | 41a340d | 2008-01-22 12:25:31 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6311 | be smaller than "timeout server". |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 5259dfe | 2008-01-21 01:54:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6312 | |
| 6313 | This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in |
| 6314 | "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to |
| 6315 | forget about it. |
| 6316 | |
Willy Tarreau | 41a340d | 2008-01-22 12:25:31 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6317 | See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server", |
| 6318 | "timeout tarpit". |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 5259dfe | 2008-01-21 01:54:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6319 | |
| 6320 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6321 | timeout client <timeout> |
| 6322 | timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated) |
| 6323 | Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side. |
| 6324 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6325 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 6326 | Arguments : |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6327 | <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6328 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 6329 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 6330 | |
| 6331 | The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or |
| 6332 | send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider |
| 6333 | during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the |
| 6334 | response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified |
| 6335 | in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is |
| 6336 | suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode |
| 6337 | (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the |
| 6338 | client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6339 | situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6340 | losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds |
Willy Tarreau | ce887fd | 2012-05-12 12:50:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6341 | (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived |
| 6342 | sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel", |
| 6343 | which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6344 | |
| 6345 | This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in |
| 6346 | "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to |
| 6347 | forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which |
| 6348 | is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning |
| 6349 | during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in |
| 6350 | the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either. |
| 6351 | |
| 6352 | This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended |
| 6353 | to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is |
| 6354 | provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged. |
| 6355 | |
Willy Tarreau | ce887fd | 2012-05-12 12:50:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6356 | See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel". |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6357 | |
| 6358 | |
| 6359 | timeout connect <timeout> |
| 6360 | timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated) |
| 6361 | Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed. |
| 6362 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6363 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 6364 | Arguments : |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6365 | <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6366 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 6367 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 6368 | |
| 6369 | If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6370 | immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6371 | cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6372 | slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 5259dfe | 2008-01-21 01:54:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6373 | connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value |
| 6374 | if these have not been specified. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6375 | |
| 6376 | This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in |
| 6377 | "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to |
| 6378 | forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which |
| 6379 | is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning |
| 6380 | during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in |
| 6381 | the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either. |
| 6382 | |
| 6383 | This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended |
| 6384 | to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is |
| 6385 | provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged. |
| 6386 | |
Willy Tarreau | 41a340d | 2008-01-22 12:25:31 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6387 | See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout", |
| 6388 | "timeout tarpit". |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6389 | |
| 6390 | |
Willy Tarreau | b16a574 | 2010-01-10 14:46:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6391 | timeout http-keep-alive <timeout> |
| 6392 | Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear |
| 6393 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6394 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 6395 | Arguments : |
| 6396 | <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but |
| 6397 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 6398 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 6399 | |
| 6400 | By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set |
| 6401 | by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some |
| 6402 | people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections |
| 6403 | faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts |
| 6404 | once the request has started to present itself. |
| 6405 | |
| 6406 | The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to |
| 6407 | wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once |
| 6408 | the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used |
| 6409 | to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a |
| 6410 | new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request. |
| 6411 | |
| 6412 | There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection |
| 6413 | expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection |
| 6414 | just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a |
| 6415 | connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned. |
| 6416 | |
| 6417 | In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of |
| 6418 | milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but |
| 6419 | without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg: |
| 6420 | 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the |
| 6421 | non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running |
Patrick Mézard | 2382ad6 | 2010-05-09 10:43:32 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6422 | with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients. |
Willy Tarreau | b16a574 | 2010-01-10 14:46:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6423 | |
| 6424 | If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both |
| 6425 | are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be |
| 6426 | set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in |
| 6427 | which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used. |
| 6428 | |
| 6429 | See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client". |
| 6430 | |
| 6431 | |
Willy Tarreau | 036fae0 | 2008-01-06 13:24:40 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6432 | timeout http-request <timeout> |
| 6433 | Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request |
| 6434 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
Willy Tarreau | cd7afc0 | 2009-07-12 10:03:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6435 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | 036fae0 | 2008-01-06 13:24:40 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6436 | Arguments : |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6437 | <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but |
Willy Tarreau | 036fae0 | 2008-01-06 13:24:40 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6438 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 6439 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 6440 | |
| 6441 | In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum |
| 6442 | accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client |
| 6443 | timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which |
| 6444 | nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against |
| 6445 | this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the |
| 6446 | attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not |
| 6447 | trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client |
| 6448 | types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. |
| 6449 | |
| 6450 | Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and |
| 6451 | not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not |
Willy Tarreau | b16a574 | 2010-01-10 14:46:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6452 | used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second |
| 6453 | request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set. |
Willy Tarreau | 036fae0 | 2008-01-06 13:24:40 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6454 | |
| 6455 | Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the |
| 6456 | full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP |
| 6457 | retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will |
| 6458 | generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This |
| 6459 | will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet. |
| 6460 | |
| 6461 | If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each |
Willy Tarreau | cd7afc0 | 2009-07-12 10:03:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6462 | chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take |
| 6463 | effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's |
| 6464 | timeout will be used. |
Willy Tarreau | 036fae0 | 2008-01-06 13:24:40 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6465 | |
Willy Tarreau | b16a574 | 2010-01-10 14:46:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6466 | See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client". |
Willy Tarreau | 036fae0 | 2008-01-06 13:24:40 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6467 | |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6468 | |
| 6469 | timeout queue <timeout> |
| 6470 | Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free |
| 6471 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6472 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 6473 | Arguments : |
| 6474 | <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but |
| 6475 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 6476 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 6477 | |
| 6478 | When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue |
| 6479 | which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait |
| 6480 | indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the |
| 6481 | timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be |
| 6482 | served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client. |
| 6483 | |
| 6484 | The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to |
| 6485 | be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's |
| 6486 | connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility |
| 6487 | with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter. |
| 6488 | |
| 6489 | See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout". |
| 6490 | |
| 6491 | |
| 6492 | timeout server <timeout> |
| 6493 | timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated) |
| 6494 | Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side. |
| 6495 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6496 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 6497 | Arguments : |
| 6498 | <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but |
| 6499 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 6500 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 6501 | |
| 6502 | The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or |
| 6503 | send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider |
| 6504 | during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the |
| 6505 | headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the |
| 6506 | request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with |
| 6507 | what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs |
| 6508 | to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly. |
| 6509 | |
| 6510 | The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other |
| 6511 | unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this |
| 6512 | document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly |
| 6513 | recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in |
| 6514 | order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6515 | response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6516 | packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 |
Willy Tarreau | ce887fd | 2012-05-12 12:50:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6517 | seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed |
| 6518 | with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering |
| 6519 | "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for |
| 6520 | tunnels. |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6521 | |
| 6522 | This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in |
| 6523 | "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to |
| 6524 | forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which |
| 6525 | is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning |
| 6526 | during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in |
| 6527 | the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either. |
| 6528 | |
| 6529 | This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended |
| 6530 | to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is |
| 6531 | provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged. |
| 6532 | |
Willy Tarreau | ce887fd | 2012-05-12 12:50:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6533 | See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel". |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6534 | |
| 6535 | |
| 6536 | timeout tarpit <timeout> |
Cyril Bonté | 78caf84 | 2010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6537 | Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6538 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6539 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 6540 | Arguments : |
| 6541 | <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but |
| 6542 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 6543 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 6544 | |
| 6545 | When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with |
| 6546 | no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" |
| 6547 | defines how long it will be maintained open. |
| 6548 | |
| 6549 | The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other |
| 6550 | unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this |
| 6551 | document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout |
| 6552 | ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions |
Cyril Bonté | 78caf84 | 2010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6553 | with no "timeout tarpit" parameter. |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6554 | |
| 6555 | See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout". |
| 6556 | |
| 6557 | |
Willy Tarreau | ce887fd | 2012-05-12 12:50:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6558 | timeout tunnel <timeout> |
| 6559 | Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels. |
| 6560 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6561 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 6562 | Arguments : |
| 6563 | <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but |
| 6564 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 6565 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 6566 | |
| 6567 | The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectionnal connection is established |
| 6568 | between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both |
| 6569 | directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once |
| 6570 | the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no |
| 6571 | analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are |
| 6572 | accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg: |
| 6573 | when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request |
| 6574 | to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is |
| 6575 | specified. |
| 6576 | |
| 6577 | The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other |
| 6578 | unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this |
| 6579 | document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to |
| 6580 | cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that |
| 6581 | are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). |
| 6582 | |
| 6583 | This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in |
| 6584 | "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to |
| 6585 | forget about it. |
| 6586 | |
| 6587 | Example : |
| 6588 | defaults http |
| 6589 | option http-server-close |
| 6590 | timeout connect 5s |
| 6591 | timeout client 30s |
| 6592 | timeout client 30s |
| 6593 | timeout server 30s |
| 6594 | timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT |
| 6595 | |
| 6596 | See also : "timeout client", "timeout server". |
| 6597 | |
| 6598 | |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6599 | transparent (deprecated) |
| 6600 | Enable client-side transparent proxying |
| 6601 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
Willy Tarreau | 4b1f859 | 2008-12-23 23:13:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6602 | yes | no | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6603 | Arguments : none |
| 6604 | |
| 6605 | This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer |
| 6606 | 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming |
| 6607 | connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let |
| 6608 | this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is |
| 6609 | used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination |
| 6610 | IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another |
| 6611 | equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the |
| 6612 | appropriate server. |
| 6613 | |
| 6614 | The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead. |
| 6615 | |
| 6616 | Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy |
| 6617 | present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection. |
| 6618 | |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6619 | See also: "option transparent" |
| 6620 | |
William Lallemand | a73203e | 2012-03-12 12:48:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6621 | unique-id-format <string> |
| 6622 | Generate a unique ID for each request. |
| 6623 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6624 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 6625 | Arguments : |
| 6626 | <string> is a log-format string. |
| 6627 | |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6628 | This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A |
| 6629 | unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of |
| 6630 | a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the |
| 6631 | %ID tag the log-format string. |
William Lallemand | a73203e | 2012-03-12 12:48:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6632 | |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6633 | The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be |
| 6634 | unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances |
| 6635 | are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often |
| 6636 | needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses |
| 6637 | and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same |
| 6638 | connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them. |
| 6639 | Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter. |
| 6640 | Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart. |
William Lallemand | a73203e | 2012-03-12 12:48:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6641 | |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6642 | It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it |
| 6643 | makes them more compact and saves space in logs. |
William Lallemand | a73203e | 2012-03-12 12:48:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6644 | |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6645 | Example: |
William Lallemand | a73203e | 2012-03-12 12:48:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6646 | |
| 6647 | unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid |
| 6648 | |
| 6649 | will generate: |
| 6650 | |
| 6651 | 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A |
| 6652 | |
| 6653 | See also: "unique-id-header" |
| 6654 | |
| 6655 | unique-id-header <name> |
| 6656 | Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request. |
| 6657 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6658 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 6659 | Arguments : |
| 6660 | <name> is the name of the header. |
| 6661 | |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6662 | Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the |
| 6663 | unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist. |
William Lallemand | a73203e | 2012-03-12 12:48:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6664 | |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6665 | Example: |
William Lallemand | a73203e | 2012-03-12 12:48:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6666 | |
| 6667 | unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid |
| 6668 | unique-id-header X-Unique-ID |
| 6669 | |
| 6670 | will generate: |
| 6671 | |
| 6672 | X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A |
| 6673 | |
| 6674 | See also: "unique-id-format" |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6675 | |
| 6676 | use_backend <backend> if <condition> |
| 6677 | use_backend <backend> unless <condition> |
Willy Tarreau | 1d0dfb1 | 2009-07-07 15:10:31 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6678 | Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched. |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6679 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6680 | no | yes | yes | no |
| 6681 | Arguments : |
| 6682 | <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section. |
| 6683 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6684 | <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6685 | |
| 6686 | When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then |
| 6687 | dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The |
| 6688 | relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the |
Willy Tarreau | 1d0dfb1 | 2009-07-07 15:10:31 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6689 | "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can |
| 6690 | also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg: |
| 6691 | source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for |
| 6692 | some payload. |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6693 | |
| 6694 | There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are |
| 6695 | evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will |
| 6696 | assign the backend. |
| 6697 | |
| 6698 | In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the |
| 6699 | second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no |
| 6700 | condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used. |
| 6701 | If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are |
| 6702 | used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is |
| 6703 | used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned. |
| 6704 | |
Willy Tarreau | 51aecc7 | 2009-07-12 09:47:04 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6705 | Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6706 | this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP, |
Willy Tarreau | 51aecc7 | 2009-07-12 09:47:04 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6707 | and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for |
| 6708 | a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend |
| 6709 | must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP. |
| 6710 | |
Willy Tarreau | 1d0dfb1 | 2009-07-07 15:10:31 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6711 | See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6712 | |
Willy Tarreau | 036fae0 | 2008-01-06 13:24:40 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6713 | |
Willy Tarreau | 4a5cade | 2012-04-05 21:09:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6714 | use-server <server> if <condition> |
| 6715 | use-server <server> unless <condition> |
| 6716 | Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched. |
| 6717 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6718 | no | no | yes | yes |
| 6719 | Arguments : |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6720 | <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section. |
Willy Tarreau | 4a5cade | 2012-04-05 21:09:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6721 | |
| 6722 | <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. |
| 6723 | |
| 6724 | By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across |
| 6725 | the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a |
| 6726 | persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request. |
| 6727 | |
| 6728 | Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific |
| 6729 | server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This |
| 6730 | can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after |
| 6731 | the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence |
| 6732 | on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these |
| 6733 | rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which |
| 6734 | matches will assign the server. |
| 6735 | |
| 6736 | If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used |
| 6737 | and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on |
| 6738 | with the next rules until one matches. |
| 6739 | |
| 6740 | In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the |
| 6741 | second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no |
| 6742 | condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned |
| 6743 | according to other persistence mechanisms. |
| 6744 | |
| 6745 | Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but |
| 6746 | does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix |
| 6747 | stripped. |
| 6748 | |
| 6749 | The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it |
| 6750 | suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could |
| 6751 | be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers |
| 6752 | have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic. |
| 6753 | |
| 6754 | Example : |
| 6755 | # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field |
| 6756 | use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com } |
| 6757 | server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0 |
| 6758 | use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com } |
| 6759 | server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0 |
| 6760 | use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com } |
| 6761 | server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0 |
| 6762 | # all the rest is forwarded to this server |
| 6763 | server default 192.168.0.2:443 check |
| 6764 | |
| 6765 | See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs. |
| 6766 | |
| 6767 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c6df066 | 2010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6768 | 5. Server and default-server options |
Cyril Bonté | f0c6061 | 2010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6769 | ------------------------------------ |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6770 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c6df066 | 2010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6771 | The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings |
| 6772 | which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those |
| 6773 | arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those |
| 6774 | settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values |
| 6775 | after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name. |
| 6776 | Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's |
| 6777 | address if they are used: |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6778 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6779 | server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...] |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c6df066 | 2010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6780 | default-server [settings ...] |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6781 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6782 | The currently supported settings are the following ones. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6783 | |
Willy Tarreau | ceb4ac9 | 2012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6784 | addr <ipv4|ipv6> |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6785 | Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address |
| 6786 | to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP |
| 6787 | address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more |
| 6788 | suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if |
| 6789 | the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter. |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6790 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6791 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 6792 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6793 | backup |
| 6794 | When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load |
| 6795 | balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming |
| 6796 | with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served |
| 6797 | though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless |
| 6798 | the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups" |
| 6799 | option. |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6800 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6801 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 6802 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6803 | check |
| 6804 | This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is |
Patrick Mézard | b7aeec6 | 2012-01-22 16:01:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6805 | always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when |
| 6806 | accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve |
| 6807 | requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the |
| 6808 | server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the |
| 6809 | backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the |
| 6810 | port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source" |
| 6811 | address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall" |
| 6812 | parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk", |
| 6813 | "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please |
| 6814 | refer to those options and parameters for more information. |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6815 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6816 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 6817 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6818 | cookie <value> |
| 6819 | The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to |
| 6820 | <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first |
| 6821 | operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in |
| 6822 | cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie |
| 6823 | sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing |
| 6824 | the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and |
| 6825 | backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section. |
| 6826 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6827 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 6828 | |
Willy Tarreau | 9683909 | 2010-03-29 10:02:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6829 | disabled |
| 6830 | The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means |
| 6831 | that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the |
| 6832 | ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup |
| 6833 | new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still |
| 6834 | possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism. |
| 6835 | |
| 6836 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 6837 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6838 | error-limit <count> |
Willy Tarreau | 983e01e | 2010-01-11 18:42:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6839 | If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the |
| 6840 | number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error" |
| 6841 | option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors. |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 97f07b8 | 2009-12-15 22:31:24 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6842 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6843 | Supported in default-server: Yes |
| 6844 | |
| 6845 | See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error". |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 97f07b8 | 2009-12-15 22:31:24 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6846 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6847 | fall <count> |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6848 | The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after |
| 6849 | <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if |
| 6850 | unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters. |
| 6851 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6852 | Supported in default-server: Yes |
| 6853 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6854 | id <value> |
Willy Tarreau | 53fb4ae | 2009-10-04 23:04:08 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6855 | Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for |
| 6856 | the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first |
| 6857 | assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics. |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6858 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6859 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 6860 | |
| 6861 | inter <delay> |
| 6862 | fastinter <delay> |
| 6863 | downinter <delay> |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6864 | The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks |
| 6865 | to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms. |
| 6866 | It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays |
| 6867 | between checks depending on the server state : |
| 6868 | |
| 6869 | Server state | Interval used |
| 6870 | ---------------------------------+----------------------------------------- |
| 6871 | UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter" |
| 6872 | ---------------------------------+----------------------------------------- |
| 6873 | Transitionally UP (going down), | |
| 6874 | Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise. |
| 6875 | or yet unchecked. | |
| 6876 | ---------------------------------+----------------------------------------- |
| 6877 | DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise. |
| 6878 | ---------------------------------+----------------------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6879 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6880 | Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any |
| 6881 | other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also |
| 6882 | serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is |
| 6883 | not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are |
| 6884 | hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started |
| 6885 | with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random |
| 6886 | noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks" |
| 6887 | keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same |
| 6888 | servers. |
| 6889 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6890 | Supported in default-server: Yes |
| 6891 | |
| 6892 | maxconn <maxconn> |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6893 | The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent |
| 6894 | connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming |
| 6895 | concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting |
| 6896 | for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can |
| 6897 | save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn" |
| 6898 | parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0" |
| 6899 | which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and |
| 6900 | the backend's "fullconn" keyword. |
| 6901 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6902 | Supported in default-server: Yes |
| 6903 | |
| 6904 | maxqueue <maxqueue> |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6905 | The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which |
| 6906 | will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next |
| 6907 | requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely |
| 6908 | waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to |
| 6909 | quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The |
| 6910 | default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the |
| 6911 | "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters. |
| 6912 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6913 | Supported in default-server: Yes |
| 6914 | |
| 6915 | minconn <minconn> |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6916 | When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic |
| 6917 | limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least |
| 6918 | <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on |
| 6919 | the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn> |
| 6920 | concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the |
| 6921 | server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6922 | overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn" |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6923 | and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword. |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 97f07b8 | 2009-12-15 22:31:24 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6924 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6925 | Supported in default-server: Yes |
| 6926 | |
Simon Horman | fa46168 | 2011-06-25 09:39:49 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 6927 | non-stick |
| 6928 | Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table. |
| 6929 | This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that |
| 6930 | stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers. |
| 6931 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 97f07b8 | 2009-12-15 22:31:24 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6932 | observe <mode> |
| 6933 | This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with |
| 6934 | the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also |
| 6935 | requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and |
| 6936 | "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are |
| 6937 | significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses |
| 6938 | received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable |
Willy Tarreau | 150d146 | 2012-03-10 08:19:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6939 | headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505. |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 97f07b8 | 2009-12-15 22:31:24 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6940 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6941 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 6942 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 97f07b8 | 2009-12-15 22:31:24 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6943 | See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit". |
| 6944 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6945 | on-error <mode> |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 97f07b8 | 2009-12-15 22:31:24 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6946 | Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected. |
| 6947 | Currently, four modes are available: |
| 6948 | - fastinter: force fastinter |
| 6949 | - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default) |
| 6950 | - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed |
| 6951 | check will mark a server down, forces fastinter |
| 6952 | - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter |
| 6953 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6954 | Supported in default-server: Yes |
| 6955 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 97f07b8 | 2009-12-15 22:31:24 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6956 | See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit". |
| 6957 | |
Simon Horman | e0d1bfb | 2011-06-21 14:34:58 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 6958 | on-marked-down <action> |
| 6959 | Modify what occurs when a server is marked down. |
| 6960 | Currently one action is available: |
| 6961 | - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions |
| 6962 | |
| 6963 | Actions are disabled by default |
| 6964 | |
| 6965 | Supported in default-server: Yes |
| 6966 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6967 | port <port> |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6968 | Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to |
| 6969 | send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port |
| 6970 | to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable |
| 6971 | to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in |
| 6972 | inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not |
| 6973 | set. See also the "addr" parameter. |
| 6974 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6975 | Supported in default-server: Yes |
| 6976 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6977 | redir <prefix> |
| 6978 | The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD |
| 6979 | requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy |
| 6980 | forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with |
| 6981 | the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the |
| 6982 | requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means |
| 6983 | that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests |
| 6984 | will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by |
| 6985 | the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6986 | mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6987 | requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct |
| 6988 | users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in |
| 6989 | increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly |
| 6990 | connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a |
| 6991 | loop between the client and HAProxy! |
| 6992 | |
| 6993 | Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check |
| 6994 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6995 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 6996 | |
| 6997 | rise <count> |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6998 | The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational |
| 6999 | after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2 |
| 7000 | if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters. |
| 7001 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7002 | Supported in default-server: Yes |
| 7003 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5ab04ec | 2011-03-20 10:32:26 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7004 | send-proxy |
| 7005 | The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any |
| 7006 | connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other |
| 7007 | end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can |
| 7008 | know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the |
| 7009 | upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener, |
| 7010 | the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families |
| 7011 | are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN |
| 7012 | family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of |
| 7013 | haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be |
| 7014 | used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" |
| 7015 | option of the "bind" keyword. |
| 7016 | |
| 7017 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7018 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7019 | slowstart <start_time_in_ms> |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7020 | The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which |
| 7021 | indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at |
| 7022 | full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered |
| 7023 | in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows |
| 7024 | linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two |
| 7025 | parameters : |
| 7026 | |
| 7027 | - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1 |
| 7028 | to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn). |
| 7029 | |
| 7030 | - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight |
| 7031 | grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every |
| 7032 | health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter |
| 7033 | is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps. |
| 7034 | |
| 7035 | The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause |
| 7036 | trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously |
| 7037 | seen as failed. |
| 7038 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7039 | Supported in default-server: Yes |
| 7040 | |
Willy Tarreau | c6f4ce8 | 2009-06-10 11:09:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7041 | source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ] |
Willy Tarreau | bce7088 | 2009-09-07 11:51:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7042 | source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ] |
Willy Tarreau | c6f4ce8 | 2009-06-10 11:09:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7043 | source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ... |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7044 | The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when |
| 7045 | connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle |
| 7046 | as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server |
| 7047 | referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details. |
| 7048 | |
Willy Tarreau | c6f4ce8 | 2009-06-10 11:09:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7049 | Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a |
| 7050 | source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a |
| 7051 | dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a |
| 7052 | source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for |
| 7053 | several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k |
| 7054 | total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per |
| 7055 | server. |
| 7056 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7057 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7058 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7059 | track [<proxy>/]<server> |
| 7060 | This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by |
| 7061 | tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked |
| 7062 | so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another |
| 7063 | one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is |
| 7064 | used, it has to be enabled on both proxies. |
| 7065 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7066 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7067 | |
| 7068 | weight <weight> |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7069 | The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to |
| 7070 | other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight |
| 7071 | relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the |
Willy Tarreau | 6704d67 | 2009-06-15 10:56:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7072 | load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0 |
| 7073 | means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept |
| 7074 | persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load |
| 7075 | according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which |
| 7076 | can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough |
| 7077 | room above and below for later adjustments. |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7078 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7079 | Supported in default-server: Yes |
| 7080 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7081 | |
| 7082 | 6. HTTP header manipulation |
| 7083 | --------------------------- |
| 7084 | |
| 7085 | In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and |
| 7086 | response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a |
| 7087 | request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression, |
| 7088 | which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect |
| 7089 | against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation |
| 7090 | to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers |
| 7091 | passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent |
| 7092 | headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy |
| 7093 | never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers. |
| 7094 | |
Willy Tarreau | 816b979 | 2009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7095 | There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" |
| 7096 | (status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, |
| 7097 | rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such |
| 7098 | messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers |
| 7099 | in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7100 | happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally |
Willy Tarreau | 816b979 | 2009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7101 | add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, |
| 7102 | normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages. |
| 7103 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7104 | This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail |
| 7105 | in section 4.2 : |
| 7106 | |
| 7107 | - reqadd <string> |
| 7108 | - reqallow <search> |
| 7109 | - reqiallow <search> |
| 7110 | - reqdel <search> |
| 7111 | - reqidel <search> |
| 7112 | - reqdeny <search> |
| 7113 | - reqideny <search> |
| 7114 | - reqpass <search> |
| 7115 | - reqipass <search> |
| 7116 | - reqrep <search> <replace> |
| 7117 | - reqirep <search> <replace> |
| 7118 | - reqtarpit <search> |
| 7119 | - reqitarpit <search> |
| 7120 | - rspadd <string> |
| 7121 | - rspdel <search> |
| 7122 | - rspidel <search> |
| 7123 | - rspdeny <search> |
| 7124 | - rspideny <search> |
| 7125 | - rsprep <search> <replace> |
| 7126 | - rspirep <search> <replace> |
| 7127 | |
| 7128 | With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter |
| 7129 | is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through |
| 7130 | parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be |
| 7131 | prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter. |
| 7132 | Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning : |
| 7133 | |
| 7134 | \t for a tab |
| 7135 | \r for a carriage return (CR) |
| 7136 | \n for a new line (LF) |
| 7137 | \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter |
| 7138 | \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment |
| 7139 | \\ to use a backslash in a regex |
| 7140 | \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy) |
| 7141 | \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language |
| 7142 | |
| 7143 | The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest |
| 7144 | portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters |
| 7145 | above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the |
| 7146 | regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to |
| 7147 | 9 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice |
| 7148 | is very common to users of the "sed" program. |
| 7149 | |
| 7150 | The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added |
| 7151 | after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above. |
| 7152 | |
| 7153 | Notes related to these keywords : |
| 7154 | --------------------------------- |
| 7155 | - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header |
| 7156 | contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword |
| 7157 | instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules. |
| 7158 | |
| 7159 | - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference |
| 7160 | a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way |
| 7161 | headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon). |
| 7162 | |
| 7163 | - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to |
| 7164 | rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes |
| 7165 | it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix |
| 7166 | ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix |
| 7167 | ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon. |
| 7168 | |
| 7169 | - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to |
| 7170 | a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This |
| 7171 | should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short |
| 7172 | on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some |
| 7173 | useless headers before adding new ones. |
| 7174 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7175 | - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7176 | without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns. |
| 7177 | |
| 7178 | - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules |
| 7179 | from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend |
| 7180 | will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses. |
| 7181 | |
| 7182 | - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is |
| 7183 | always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7184 | before switching. |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7185 | |
| 7186 | |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7187 | 7. Using ACLs and pattern extraction |
| 7188 | ------------------------------------ |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7189 | |
| 7190 | The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform |
| 7191 | content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted |
| 7192 | from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is |
| 7193 | simple : |
| 7194 | |
| 7195 | - define test criteria with sets of values |
| 7196 | - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid |
| 7197 | |
| 7198 | The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend. |
| 7199 | |
| 7200 | In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is : |
| 7201 | |
| 7202 | acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ... |
| 7203 | |
| 7204 | This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests. |
| 7205 | Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion> |
| 7206 | and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support |
| 7207 | an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are |
| 7208 | of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces. |
| 7209 | |
| 7210 | ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash), |
| 7211 | '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive, |
| 7212 | which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs. |
| 7213 | |
| 7214 | There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect |
| 7215 | performance, they just consume a small amount of memory. |
| 7216 | |
| 7217 | The following ACL flags are currently supported : |
| 7218 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2b5285d | 2010-05-09 23:45:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7219 | -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns. |
| 7220 | -f : load patterns from a file. |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7221 | -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags. |
| 7222 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2b5285d | 2010-05-09 23:45:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7223 | The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file |
| 7224 | specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even |
| 7225 | possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from |
Willy Tarreau | 58215a0 | 2010-05-13 22:07:43 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7226 | multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will |
| 7227 | be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely |
| 7228 | needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a |
| 7229 | space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and |
| 7230 | match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast |
| 7231 | lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case, |
| 7232 | duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies |
| 7233 | to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For |
| 7234 | instance : |
Willy Tarreau | 2b5285d | 2010-05-09 23:45:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7235 | |
| 7236 | acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test |
| 7237 | |
| 7238 | In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against |
| 7239 | the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be |
| 7240 | case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched |
| 7241 | too. |
| 7242 | |
| 7243 | Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if |
| 7244 | a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the |
| 7245 | ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes. |
| 7246 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7247 | Supported types of values are : |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7248 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7249 | - integers or integer ranges |
| 7250 | - strings |
| 7251 | - regular expressions |
| 7252 | - IP addresses and networks |
| 7253 | |
| 7254 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7255 | 7.1. Matching integers |
| 7256 | ---------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7257 | |
| 7258 | Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note |
| 7259 | that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value |
| 7260 | expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which |
| 7261 | may be omitted. |
| 7262 | |
| 7263 | For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of |
| 7264 | unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid |
| 7265 | representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work. |
| 7266 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7267 | As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact |
| 7268 | two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for |
| 7269 | instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including |
| 7270 | ranges and operators. |
| 7271 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7272 | For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7273 | operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged. |
| 7274 | Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set |
| 7275 | of values. |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7276 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7277 | Available operators for integer matching are : |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7278 | |
| 7279 | eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value |
| 7280 | ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value |
| 7281 | gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value |
| 7282 | le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value |
| 7283 | lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value |
| 7284 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7285 | For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header : |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7286 | |
| 7287 | acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0 |
| 7288 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7289 | This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) : |
| 7290 | |
| 7291 | acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1 |
| 7292 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7293 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7294 | 7.2. Matching strings |
| 7295 | --------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7296 | |
| 7297 | String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the |
| 7298 | exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some |
| 7299 | characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first |
| 7300 | string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order |
| 7301 | to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7302 | before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--". |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7303 | |
| 7304 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7305 | 7.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes) |
| 7306 | ------------------------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7307 | |
| 7308 | Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as |
| 7309 | they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it |
| 7310 | possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is |
| 7311 | passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring |
| 7312 | the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7313 | the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to |
| 7314 | match the string "--". |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7315 | |
| 7316 | |
Willy Tarreau | ceb4ac9 | 2012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7317 | 7.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7318 | ---------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7319 | |
| 7320 | IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a |
| 7321 | netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is |
| 7322 | within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7323 | host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7324 | difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should |
| 7325 | at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration |
| 7326 | does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is |
| 7327 | parsed. |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7328 | |
Willy Tarreau | ceb4ac9 | 2012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7329 | IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended. |
| 7330 | Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of |
| 7331 | trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in |
| 7332 | IPv6 patterns. |
| 7333 | |
| 7334 | HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the |
| 7335 | following situations : |
| 7336 | - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies |
| 7337 | in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any. |
| 7338 | - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies |
| 7339 | in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any. |
| 7340 | - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4 |
| 7341 | using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::, |
| 7342 | ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails. |
| 7343 | - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first |
| 7344 | converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is |
| 7345 | applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask. |
| 7346 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7347 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7348 | 7.5. Available matching criteria |
| 7349 | -------------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7350 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7351 | 7.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below |
| 7352 | ------------------------------------ |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7353 | |
| 7354 | A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any |
| 7355 | analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP |
| 7356 | addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream. |
| 7357 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7358 | always_false |
| 7359 | This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as |
| 7360 | a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations. |
| 7361 | |
| 7362 | always_true |
| 7363 | This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as |
| 7364 | a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations. |
| 7365 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7366 | avg_queue <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7367 | avg_queue(<backend>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7368 | Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend |
| 7369 | divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue" |
| 7370 | except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more |
| 7371 | accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be |
| 7372 | processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it |
| 7373 | becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event |
| 7374 | there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the |
| 7375 | number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate, |
| 7376 | as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send |
| 7377 | new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue", |
| 7378 | "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria. |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 346f76d | 2010-01-12 21:59:30 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7379 | |
Willy Tarreau | a36af91 | 2009-10-10 12:02:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7380 | be_conn <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7381 | be_conn(<backend>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | a36af91 | 2009-10-10 12:02:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7382 | Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend, |
| 7383 | possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is |
| 7384 | specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another |
| 7385 | backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full. |
| 7386 | See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria. |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7387 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | 35ed801 | 2010-12-15 14:04:51 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7388 | be_id <integer> |
| 7389 | Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which |
| 7390 | backend it was called. |
| 7391 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7392 | be_sess_rate <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7393 | be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7394 | Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the |
| 7395 | specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is |
| 7396 | used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one |
| 7397 | reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent |
| 7398 | sucking of an online dictionary). |
| 7399 | |
| 7400 | Example : |
| 7401 | # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often |
| 7402 | backend dynamic |
| 7403 | mode http |
| 7404 | acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100 |
| 7405 | redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7406 | |
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim | 5051d7b | 2008-09-04 01:03:03 +0800 | [diff] [blame] | 7407 | connslots <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7408 | connslots(<backend>) <integer> |
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim | 5051d7b | 2008-09-04 01:03:03 +0800 | [diff] [blame] | 7409 | The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots" |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7410 | still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended |
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim | 5051d7b | 2008-09-04 01:03:03 +0800 | [diff] [blame] | 7411 | usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend. |
| 7412 | |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7413 | 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of |
| 7414 | available server queue slots. |
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim | 5051d7b | 2008-09-04 01:03:03 +0800 | [diff] [blame] | 7415 | |
Willy Tarreau | a36af91 | 2009-10-10 12:02:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7416 | Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7417 | useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into |
| 7418 | multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and |
| 7419 | you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their |
| 7420 | available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are |
| 7421 | actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of |
Willy Tarreau | a36af91 | 2009-10-10 12:02:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7422 | available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue". |
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim | 5051d7b | 2008-09-04 01:03:03 +0800 | [diff] [blame] | 7423 | |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7424 | OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care |
| 7425 | of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0, |
| 7426 | then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned |
| 7427 | will be -1. |
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim | 5051d7b | 2008-09-04 01:03:03 +0800 | [diff] [blame] | 7428 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7429 | dst <ip_address> |
Willy Tarreau | ceb4ac9 | 2012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7430 | Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be |
| 7431 | used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses. |
Willy Tarreau | a36af91 | 2009-10-10 12:02:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7432 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7433 | dst_conn <integer> |
| 7434 | Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket |
| 7435 | including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry |
| 7436 | page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests |
| 7437 | when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign |
| 7438 | different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the |
| 7439 | "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria. |
| 7440 | |
| 7441 | dst_port <integer> |
| 7442 | Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch |
| 7443 | to a different backend for some alternative ports. |
| 7444 | |
| 7445 | fe_conn <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7446 | fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7447 | Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend, |
| 7448 | possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is |
| 7449 | specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another |
| 7450 | frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking, |
| 7451 | or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is |
| 7452 | considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate" |
| 7453 | criteria. |
| 7454 | |
| 7455 | fe_id <integer> |
Cyril Bonté | 78caf84 | 2010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7456 | Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7457 | frontend it was called. |
Willy Tarreau | a36af91 | 2009-10-10 12:02:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7458 | |
Willy Tarreau | 079ff0a | 2009-03-05 21:34:28 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7459 | fe_sess_rate <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7460 | fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | 079ff0a | 2009-03-05 21:34:28 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7461 | Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named |
| 7462 | frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions |
| 7463 | per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in |
| 7464 | order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be |
| 7465 | combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for |
| 7466 | the rate to go down below the limit. |
| 7467 | |
| 7468 | Example : |
| 7469 | # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100 |
| 7470 | # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and |
| 7471 | # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to |
| 7472 | # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second. |
| 7473 | frontend mail |
| 7474 | bind :25 |
| 7475 | mode tcp |
| 7476 | maxconn 100 |
| 7477 | acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10 |
| 7478 | tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms |
| 7479 | tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast |
| 7480 | tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7481 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7482 | nbsrv <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7483 | nbsrv(<backend>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7484 | Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend |
| 7485 | or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to |
| 7486 | switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to |
| 7487 | to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with |
| 7488 | "monitor fail". |
Willy Tarreau | 079ff0a | 2009-03-05 21:34:28 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7489 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7490 | queue <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7491 | queue(<backend>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7492 | Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend, |
| 7493 | including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is |
| 7494 | specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another |
| 7495 | one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, |
| 7496 | generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. |
| 7497 | One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. |
| 7498 | See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria. |
| 7499 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7500 | sc1_bytes_in_rate |
| 7501 | sc2_bytes_in_rate |
| 7502 | Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked |
| 7503 | counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the |
| 7504 | table. See also src_bytes_in_rate. |
| 7505 | |
| 7506 | sc1_bytes_out_rate |
| 7507 | sc2_bytes_out_rate |
| 7508 | Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked |
| 7509 | counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the |
| 7510 | table. See also src_bytes_out_rate. |
| 7511 | |
Willy Tarreau | f73cd11 | 2011-08-13 01:45:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7512 | sc1_clr_gpc0 |
| 7513 | sc2_clr_gpc0 |
| 7514 | Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked |
| 7515 | counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the |
| 7516 | stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test |
| 7517 | can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a |
| 7518 | second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL |
| 7519 | was verified : |
| 7520 | |
| 7521 | # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess |
| 7522 | # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down. |
| 7523 | acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10 |
| 7524 | acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5 |
| 7525 | acl save sc1_clr_gpc0 |
| 7526 | tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save |
| 7527 | tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill |
| 7528 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7529 | sc1_conn_cnt |
| 7530 | sc2_conn_cnt |
| 7531 | Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked |
| 7532 | counters. See also src_conn_cnt. |
| 7533 | |
| 7534 | sc1_conn_cur |
| 7535 | sc2_conn_cur |
| 7536 | Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same |
| 7537 | tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking |
| 7538 | begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur. |
| 7539 | |
| 7540 | sc1_conn_rate |
| 7541 | sc2_conn_rate |
| 7542 | Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters, |
| 7543 | measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. |
| 7544 | See also src_conn_rate. |
| 7545 | |
| 7546 | sc1_get_gpc0 |
| 7547 | sc2_get_gpc0 |
| 7548 | Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the |
| 7549 | currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. |
| 7550 | |
| 7551 | sc1_http_err_cnt |
| 7552 | sc2_http_err_cnt |
| 7553 | Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked |
| 7554 | counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. |
| 7555 | See also src_http_err_cnt. |
| 7556 | |
| 7557 | sc1_http_err_rate |
| 7558 | sc2_http_err_rate |
| 7559 | Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters, |
| 7560 | measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This |
| 7561 | includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also |
| 7562 | src_http_err_rate. |
| 7563 | |
| 7564 | sc1_http_req_cnt |
| 7565 | sc2_http_req_cnt |
| 7566 | Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked |
| 7567 | counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also |
| 7568 | src_http_req_cnt. |
| 7569 | |
| 7570 | sc1_http_req_rate |
| 7571 | sc2_http_req_rate |
| 7572 | Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked |
| 7573 | counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in |
| 7574 | the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also |
| 7575 | src_http_req_rate. |
| 7576 | |
| 7577 | sc1_inc_gpc0 |
| 7578 | sc2_inc_gpc0 |
| 7579 | Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently |
| 7580 | tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the |
| 7581 | stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will |
| 7582 | return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is |
| 7583 | typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection |
| 7584 | when a first ACL was verified : |
| 7585 | |
| 7586 | acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10 |
| 7587 | acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 |
| 7588 | tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill |
| 7589 | |
| 7590 | sc1_kbytes_in |
| 7591 | sc2_kbytes_in |
| 7592 | Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked |
| 7593 | counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The |
| 7594 | test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4 |
| 7595 | terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in. |
| 7596 | |
| 7597 | sc1_kbytes_out |
| 7598 | sc2_kbytes_out |
| 7599 | Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked |
| 7600 | counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The |
| 7601 | test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4 |
| 7602 | terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out. |
| 7603 | |
| 7604 | sc1_sess_cnt |
| 7605 | sc2_sess_cnt |
| 7606 | Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed |
| 7607 | into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request |
| 7608 | connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count |
| 7609 | more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many |
| 7610 | backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection |
| 7611 | with the client. See also src_sess_cnt. |
| 7612 | |
| 7613 | sc1_sess_rate |
| 7614 | sc2_sess_rate |
| 7615 | Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters, |
| 7616 | measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A |
| 7617 | session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection" |
| 7618 | rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each |
| 7619 | connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is |
| 7620 | performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate. |
| 7621 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7622 | so_id <integer> |
| 7623 | Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords. |
| 7624 | |
| 7625 | src <ip_address> |
Willy Tarreau | ceb4ac9 | 2012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7626 | Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit |
| 7627 | access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level |
| 7628 | source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy. |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7629 | |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7630 | src_bytes_in_rate <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7631 | src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7632 | Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in |
| 7633 | the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in |
| 7634 | amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7635 | not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7636 | |
| 7637 | src_bytes_out_rate <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7638 | src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7639 | Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the |
| 7640 | current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in |
| 7641 | amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7642 | not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7643 | |
Willy Tarreau | f73cd11 | 2011-08-13 01:45:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7644 | src_clr_gpc0 <integer> |
| 7645 | src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer> |
| 7646 | Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's |
| 7647 | source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated |
| 7648 | stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an |
| 7649 | entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and |
| 7650 | always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression |
| 7651 | in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified : |
| 7652 | |
| 7653 | # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess |
| 7654 | # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down. |
| 7655 | acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10 |
| 7656 | acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5 |
| 7657 | acl save src_clr_gpc0 |
| 7658 | tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save |
| 7659 | tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill |
| 7660 | |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7661 | src_conn_cnt <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7662 | src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7663 | Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current |
| 7664 | connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in |
| 7665 | the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned. |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7666 | See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7667 | |
| 7668 | src_conn_cur <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7669 | src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7670 | Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the |
| 7671 | current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table |
| 7672 | or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7673 | returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7674 | |
| 7675 | src_conn_rate <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7676 | src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7677 | Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address |
| 7678 | in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured |
| 7679 | in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7680 | address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7681 | |
| 7682 | src_get_gpc0 <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7683 | src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7684 | Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the |
| 7685 | connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in |
| 7686 | the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned. |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7687 | See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7688 | |
| 7689 | src_http_err_cnt <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7690 | src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7691 | Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's |
| 7692 | source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated |
| 7693 | stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7694 | If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7695 | |
| 7696 | src_http_err_rate <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7697 | src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7698 | Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source |
| 7699 | IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick- |
| 7700 | table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. |
| 7701 | This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7702 | is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7703 | |
| 7704 | src_http_req_cnt <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7705 | src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7706 | Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's |
| 7707 | source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated |
| 7708 | stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7709 | address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7710 | |
| 7711 | src_http_req_rate <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7712 | src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7713 | Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's |
| 7714 | source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated |
| 7715 | stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the |
| 7716 | table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7717 | not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7718 | |
| 7719 | src_inc_gpc0 <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7720 | src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7721 | Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's |
| 7722 | source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated |
| 7723 | stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is |
| 7724 | created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns |
| 7725 | true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to |
| 7726 | mark a connection when a first ACL was verified : |
| 7727 | |
| 7728 | acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10 |
| 7729 | acl kill src_inc_gpc0 |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7730 | tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7731 | |
| 7732 | src_kbytes_in <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7733 | src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7734 | Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address |
| 7735 | in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured |
| 7736 | in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not |
| 7737 | found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7738 | which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7739 | |
| 7740 | src_kbytes_out <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7741 | src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7742 | Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in |
| 7743 | the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured |
| 7744 | in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not |
| 7745 | found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7746 | which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out. |
Willy Tarreau | a975b8f | 2010-06-05 19:13:27 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7747 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7748 | src_port <integer> |
| 7749 | Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage. |
Willy Tarreau | 079ff0a | 2009-03-05 21:34:28 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7750 | |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7751 | src_sess_cnt <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7752 | src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7753 | Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current |
| 7754 | connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the |
| 7755 | designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that |
| 7756 | they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7757 | is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7758 | |
| 7759 | src_sess_rate <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7760 | src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7761 | Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in |
| 7762 | the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in |
| 7763 | amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a |
| 7764 | connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7765 | found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7766 | |
| 7767 | src_updt_conn_cnt <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7768 | src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | a975b8f | 2010-06-05 19:13:27 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7769 | Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7770 | current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table |
| 7771 | must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match |
Willy Tarreau | a975b8f | 2010-06-05 19:13:27 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7772 | will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration |
| 7773 | timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return |
| 7774 | zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7775 | Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead. |
Willy Tarreau | a975b8f | 2010-06-05 19:13:27 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7776 | |
| 7777 | Example : |
| 7778 | # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for |
| 7779 | # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second |
| 7780 | # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked. |
| 7781 | listen ssh |
| 7782 | bind :22 |
| 7783 | mode tcp |
| 7784 | maxconn 100 |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7785 | stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt |
Willy Tarreau | a975b8f | 2010-06-05 19:13:27 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7786 | tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 } |
| 7787 | server local 127.0.0.1:22 |
| 7788 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7789 | srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | daa824e | 2011-08-05 12:09:44 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7790 | Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server, |
| 7791 | possibly including the connection being evaluated. |
| 7792 | It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full. |
| 7793 | See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria. |
| 7794 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | 35ed801 | 2010-12-15 14:04:51 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7795 | srv_id <integer> |
| 7796 | Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends. |
| 7797 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0b1cd94 | 2010-05-16 22:18:27 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7798 | srv_is_up(<server>) |
| 7799 | srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>) |
| 7800 | Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either |
| 7801 | DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is |
| 7802 | looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it |
| 7803 | is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external |
| 7804 | status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability). |
| 7805 | Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers |
| 7806 | as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that |
| 7807 | rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime. |
| 7808 | |
Willy Tarreau | c735a07 | 2011-03-29 00:57:02 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7809 | table_avl <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7810 | table_avl(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c735a07 | 2011-03-29 00:57:02 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7811 | Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's |
| 7812 | stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt. |
| 7813 | |
| 7814 | table_cnt <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7815 | table_cnt(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c735a07 | 2011-03-29 00:57:02 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7816 | Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's |
| 7817 | stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and |
| 7818 | table_avl for other entry counting methods. |
| 7819 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7820 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7821 | 7.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6) |
| 7822 | --------------------------------------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7823 | |
| 7824 | A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change |
| 7825 | during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7826 | through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content" |
| 7827 | keyword for more detailed information on the subject. |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7828 | |
Willy Tarreau | b6672b5 | 2011-12-12 17:23:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7829 | rep_ssl_hello_type <integer> |
| 7830 | Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3 |
| 7831 | or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>. |
| 7832 | This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a |
| 7833 | SSL session ID may be fetched. |
| 7834 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7835 | req_len <integer> |
Emeric Brun | bede3d0 | 2009-06-30 17:54:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7836 | Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7837 | specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not |
| 7838 | return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with |
| 7839 | equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the |
| 7840 | session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and |
| 7841 | return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in. |
| 7842 | This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. |
| 7843 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2492d5b | 2009-07-11 00:06:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7844 | req_proto_http |
| 7845 | Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly |
| 7846 | parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7847 | is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance |
Willy Tarreau | 2492d5b | 2009-07-11 00:06:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7848 | to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one |
| 7849 | using TCP request content inspection rules. |
| 7850 | |
Emeric Brun | bede3d0 | 2009-06-30 17:54:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7851 | req_rdp_cookie <string> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7852 | req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string> |
Emeric Brun | bede3d0 | 2009-06-30 17:54:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7853 | Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and |
| 7854 | a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is |
| 7855 | checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The |
| 7856 | parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol |
| 7857 | specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful |
| 7858 | with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client |
| 7859 | connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be |
| 7860 | used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users. |
| 7861 | |
| 7862 | req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7863 | req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer> |
Emeric Brun | bede3d0 | 2009-06-30 17:54:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7864 | Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol |
| 7865 | and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or |
| 7866 | one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way |
| 7867 | of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH |
| 7868 | cookies. |
| 7869 | |
Willy Tarreau | b6672b5 | 2011-12-12 17:23:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7870 | req_ssl_hello_type <integer> |
| 7871 | Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3 |
| 7872 | or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>. |
| 7873 | This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an |
| 7874 | SSL session ID may be fetched. |
| 7875 | |
| 7876 | req_ssl_sni <string> |
| 7877 | Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3 |
| 7878 | or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension |
| 7879 | (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the |
| 7880 | client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing |
| 7881 | or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This |
| 7882 | test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content |
| 7883 | switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client |
| 7884 | hello (type 1), like in the example below. |
| 7885 | |
| 7886 | Examples : |
| 7887 | # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds |
| 7888 | tcp-request inspect-delay 5s |
| 7889 | tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 } |
| 7890 | use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites } |
| 7891 | default_backend bk_sorry_page |
| 7892 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7893 | req_ssl_ver <decimal> |
| 7894 | Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol |
| 7895 | version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3 |
| 7896 | messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being |
| 7897 | easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the |
| 7898 | message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note |
| 7899 | that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used |
| 7900 | with TCP request content inspection. |
| 7901 | |
Willy Tarreau | b6fb420 | 2008-07-20 11:18:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7902 | wait_end |
| 7903 | Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in |
| 7904 | conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early. |
| 7905 | It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some |
| 7906 | special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately |
| 7907 | returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule. |
| 7908 | Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior |
| 7909 | declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content |
| 7910 | inspection. |
| 7911 | |
| 7912 | Examples : |
| 7913 | # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds |
| 7914 | tcp-request inspect-delay 2s |
| 7915 | tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END |
| 7916 | |
| 7917 | # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected |
| 7918 | tcp-request inspect-delay 10s |
| 7919 | acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24 |
| 7920 | acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24 |
| 7921 | tcp-request content accept if goodguys |
| 7922 | tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END |
| 7923 | tcp-request content reject |
| 7924 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7925 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7926 | 7.5.3. Matching at Layer 7 |
| 7927 | -------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7928 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7929 | A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7930 | application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been |
| 7931 | read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources |
| 7932 | than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed. |
| 7933 | |
Willy Tarreau | 04aa6a9 | 2012-04-06 18:57:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7934 | cook(<name>) <string> |
| 7935 | All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie |
| 7936 | with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are |
| 7937 | found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and |
| 7938 | the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The |
| 7939 | cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies |
| 7940 | sent by the server. |
| 7941 | |
| 7942 | The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match |
| 7943 | any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance, |
| 7944 | checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" : |
| 7945 | |
| 7946 | cook(profile) silver gold |
| 7947 | |
| 7948 | cook_beg(<name>) <string> |
| 7949 | Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the |
| 7950 | strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the |
| 7951 | scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server. |
| 7952 | |
| 7953 | cook_cnt(<name>) <integer> |
| 7954 | Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches |
| 7955 | the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or |
| 7956 | abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header |
| 7957 | matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the |
| 7958 | server. |
| 7959 | |
| 7960 | cook_dir(<name>) <string> |
| 7961 | Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings |
| 7962 | either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or |
| 7963 | directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies. |
| 7964 | See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir() |
| 7965 | variant for response cookies sent by the server. |
| 7966 | |
| 7967 | cook_dom(<name>) <string> |
| 7968 | Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings |
| 7969 | either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name |
| 7970 | matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the |
| 7971 | scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server. |
| 7972 | |
| 7973 | cook_end(<name>) <string> |
| 7974 | Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the |
| 7975 | strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the |
| 7976 | scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server. |
| 7977 | |
| 7978 | cook_len(<name>) <integer> |
| 7979 | Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches |
| 7980 | the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large |
| 7981 | cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test. |
| 7982 | See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len() |
| 7983 | variant for response cookies sent by the server. |
| 7984 | |
| 7985 | cook_reg(<name>) <regex> |
| 7986 | Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular |
| 7987 | expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that |
| 7988 | regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria, |
| 7989 | as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the |
| 7990 | scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server. |
| 7991 | |
| 7992 | cook_sub(<name>) <string> |
| 7993 | Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of |
| 7994 | the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the |
| 7995 | scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server. |
| 7996 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5153936 | 2012-05-08 12:46:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7997 | cook_val(<name>) <integer> |
| 7998 | Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which |
| 7999 | matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server |
| 8000 | based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not |
| 8001 | match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the |
| 8002 | scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server. |
| 8003 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8004 | hdr <string> |
Willy Tarreau | 185b5c4 | 2012-04-26 15:11:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8005 | hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8006 | Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a |
| 8007 | particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any |
| 8008 | space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies |
| 8009 | with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas. |
Willy Tarreau | 185b5c4 | 2012-04-26 15:11:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8010 | If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only |
| 8011 | this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from |
| 8012 | the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate |
| 8013 | positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr() |
| 8014 | variant for response headers sent by the server. |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8015 | |
| 8016 | The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria |
Willy Tarreau | 25c1ebc | 2012-04-25 16:21:44 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8017 | match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8018 | instance, checking that "connection: close" is set : |
| 8019 | |
| 8020 | hdr(Connection) -i close |
| 8021 | |
| 8022 | hdr_beg <string> |
Willy Tarreau | 185b5c4 | 2012-04-26 15:11:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8023 | hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8024 | Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See |
| 8025 | "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for |
| 8026 | response headers sent by the server. |
| 8027 | |
| 8028 | hdr_cnt <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8029 | hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8030 | Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches |
| 8031 | the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header |
| 8032 | line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to |
| 8033 | detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block |
| 8034 | request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one |
| 8035 | of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use |
| 8036 | the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server. |
| 8037 | |
| 8038 | hdr_dir <string> |
Willy Tarreau | 185b5c4 | 2012-04-26 15:11:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8039 | hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8040 | Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either |
| 8041 | isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or |
| 8042 | directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more |
| 8043 | information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response |
| 8044 | headers sent by the server. |
| 8045 | |
| 8046 | hdr_dom <string> |
Willy Tarreau | 185b5c4 | 2012-04-26 15:11:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8047 | hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8048 | Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either |
| 8049 | isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching, |
| 8050 | and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on |
| 8051 | header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the |
| 8052 | server. |
| 8053 | |
| 8054 | hdr_end <string> |
Willy Tarreau | 185b5c4 | 2012-04-26 15:11:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8055 | hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8056 | Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr" |
| 8057 | for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for |
| 8058 | response headers sent by the server. |
| 8059 | |
| 8060 | hdr_ip <ip_address> |
Willy Tarreau | ceb4ac9 | 2012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8061 | hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address> |
| 8062 | Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address |
| 8063 | matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For |
| 8064 | or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8065 | shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server. |
| 8066 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0e69854 | 2011-09-16 08:32:32 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8067 | hdr_len <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | 185b5c4 | 2012-04-26 15:11:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8068 | hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | 0e69854 | 2011-09-16 08:32:32 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8069 | Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the |
| 8070 | values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large |
| 8071 | headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the |
| 8072 | shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server. |
| 8073 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8074 | hdr_reg <regex> |
Willy Tarreau | 185b5c4 | 2012-04-26 15:11:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8075 | hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex> |
Willy Tarreau | 04aa6a9 | 2012-04-06 18:57:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8076 | Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8077 | can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching |
| 8078 | is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as |
| 8079 | "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for |
| 8080 | response headers sent by the server. |
| 8081 | |
| 8082 | hdr_sub <string> |
Willy Tarreau | 185b5c4 | 2012-04-26 15:11:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8083 | hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8084 | Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr" |
| 8085 | for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for |
| 8086 | response headers sent by the server. |
| 8087 | |
| 8088 | hdr_val <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | 185b5c4 | 2012-04-26 15:11:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8089 | hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8090 | Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the |
| 8091 | values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to |
| 8092 | acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header |
| 8093 | matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server. |
| 8094 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8095 | http_auth(<userlist>) |
| 8096 | http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]* |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8097 | Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches |
| 8098 | username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to |
| 8099 | use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one |
| 8100 | of specified groups. |
| 8101 | |
| 8102 | Currently only http basic auth is supported. |
| 8103 | |
Willy Tarreau | 85c27da | 2011-09-16 07:53:52 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8104 | http_first_req |
Willy Tarreau | 7f18e52 | 2010-10-22 20:04:13 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8105 | Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the |
| 8106 | connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing |
| 8107 | from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform |
| 8108 | some specific ACL checks only on the first request. |
| 8109 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8110 | method <string> |
| 8111 | Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL |
| 8112 | already check for most common methods. |
| 8113 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8114 | path <string> |
| 8115 | Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first |
| 8116 | slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be |
| 8117 | used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico. |
| 8118 | |
| 8119 | path_beg <string> |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8120 | Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used |
| 8121 | to send certain directory names to alternative backends. |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8122 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8123 | path_dir <string> |
| 8124 | Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with |
| 8125 | slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name |
| 8126 | matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also |
| 8127 | "url_dir" and "path_sub". |
| 8128 | |
| 8129 | path_dom <string> |
| 8130 | Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots |
| 8131 | in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy |
| 8132 | requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom". |
| 8133 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8134 | path_end <string> |
| 8135 | Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to |
| 8136 | control file name extension. |
| 8137 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0e69854 | 2011-09-16 08:32:32 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8138 | path_len <integer> |
| 8139 | Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified. |
| 8140 | This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance. |
| 8141 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8142 | path_reg <regex> |
| 8143 | Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be |
| 8144 | used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower |
| 8145 | than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria. |
| 8146 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8147 | path_sub <string> |
| 8148 | Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to |
| 8149 | detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also |
| 8150 | "path_dir". |
| 8151 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ce3aa0 | 2012-04-25 18:46:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8152 | payload(<offset>,<length>) <string> |
| 8153 | Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the |
| 8154 | request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the |
| 8155 | strings. |
| 8156 | |
| 8157 | payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) |
| 8158 | Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length> |
| 8159 | bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in |
| 8160 | the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of |
| 8161 | the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if |
| 8162 | prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. |
| 8163 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8164 | req_ver <string> |
| 8165 | Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined |
| 8166 | ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1. |
| 8167 | |
| 8168 | status <integer> |
| 8169 | Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be |
| 8170 | used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove |
| 8171 | any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. |
| 8172 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8173 | url <string> |
| 8174 | Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match |
| 8175 | "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. |
| 8176 | |
| 8177 | url_beg <string> |
| 8178 | Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to |
| 8179 | check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. |
| 8180 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8181 | url_dir <string> |
| 8182 | Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with |
| 8183 | slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name |
| 8184 | matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also |
| 8185 | "path_dir" and "url_sub". |
| 8186 | |
| 8187 | url_dom <string> |
| 8188 | Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots |
| 8189 | in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of |
| 8190 | wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub". |
| 8191 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8192 | url_end <string> |
| 8193 | Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited |
| 8194 | use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching. |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8195 | |
Willy Tarreau | ceb4ac9 | 2012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8196 | url_ip <address> |
| 8197 | Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP |
| 8198 | request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local |
| 8199 | network. It is useful with option "http_proxy". |
Alexandre Cassen | 5eb1a90 | 2007-11-29 15:43:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8200 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0e69854 | 2011-09-16 08:32:32 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8201 | url_len <integer> |
| 8202 | Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This |
| 8203 | may be used to detect abusive requests for instance. |
| 8204 | |
Alexandre Cassen | 5eb1a90 | 2007-11-29 15:43:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8205 | url_port <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8206 | Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can |
| 8207 | be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option |
Willy Tarreau | 198a744 | 2008-01-17 12:05:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8208 | "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80 |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8209 | is assumed. |
Alexandre Cassen | 5eb1a90 | 2007-11-29 15:43:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8210 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8211 | url_reg <regex> |
| 8212 | Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be |
| 8213 | used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower |
| 8214 | than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria. |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8215 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8216 | url_sub <string> |
| 8217 | Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to |
| 8218 | detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub". |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8219 | |
Willy Tarreau | 25c1ebc | 2012-04-25 16:21:44 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8220 | urlp(<name>) <string> |
| 8221 | Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the |
| 8222 | parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive. |
| 8223 | |
| 8224 | The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter |
| 8225 | matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. |
| 8226 | |
| 8227 | urlp_beg(<name>) <string> |
| 8228 | Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings. |
| 8229 | This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a |
| 8230 | protocol scheme. |
| 8231 | |
| 8232 | urlp_dir(<name>) <string> |
| 8233 | Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings |
| 8234 | either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename |
| 8235 | or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of |
| 8236 | wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub". |
| 8237 | |
| 8238 | urlp_dom(<name>) <string> |
| 8239 | Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots |
| 8240 | in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching |
| 8241 | in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding |
| 8242 | prefixes. See also "urlp_sub". |
| 8243 | |
| 8244 | urlp_end(<name>) <string> |
| 8245 | Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings. |
| 8246 | |
| 8247 | urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address> |
Willy Tarreau | ceb4ac9 | 2012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8248 | Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address |
| 8249 | which matches one of the specified addresses. |
Willy Tarreau | 25c1ebc | 2012-04-25 16:21:44 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8250 | |
| 8251 | urlp_len(<name>) <integer> |
| 8252 | Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values |
| 8253 | or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance. |
| 8254 | |
| 8255 | urlp_reg(<name>) <regex> |
| 8256 | Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular |
| 8257 | expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that |
| 8258 | regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all |
| 8259 | "urlp_" criteria. |
| 8260 | |
| 8261 | urlp_sub(<name>) <string> |
| 8262 | Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It |
| 8263 | can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See |
| 8264 | also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria. |
| 8265 | |
Willy Tarreau | 198a744 | 2008-01-17 12:05:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8266 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8267 | 7.6. Pre-defined ACLs |
| 8268 | --------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8269 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8270 | Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in |
| 8271 | every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in |
Patrick Mézard | 2382ad6 | 2010-05-09 10:43:32 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8272 | order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below. |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8273 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8274 | ACL name Equivalent to Usage |
| 8275 | ---------------+-----------------------------+--------------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8276 | FALSE always_false never match |
Willy Tarreau | 2492d5b | 2009-07-11 00:06:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8277 | HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8278 | HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0 |
| 8279 | HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1 |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8280 | HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length |
| 8281 | HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme |
| 8282 | HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/" |
| 8283 | HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*" |
| 8284 | LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8285 | METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method |
| 8286 | METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method |
| 8287 | METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method |
| 8288 | METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method |
| 8289 | METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method |
| 8290 | METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method |
Emeric Brun | bede3d0 | 2009-06-30 17:54:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8291 | RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8292 | REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8293 | TRUE always_true always match |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8294 | WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis |
| 8295 | ---------------+-----------------------------+--------------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8296 | |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8297 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8298 | 7.7. Using ACLs to form conditions |
| 8299 | ---------------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8300 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8301 | Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a |
| 8302 | combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported : |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8303 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8304 | - AND (implicit) |
| 8305 | - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator) |
| 8306 | - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!") |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8307 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8308 | A condition is formed as a disjunctive form: |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8309 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8310 | [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ... |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8311 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8312 | Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement, |
| 8313 | indicating when the condition will trigger the action. |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8314 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8315 | For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than |
| 8316 | "OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD |
| 8317 | requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which |
| 8318 | is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS ! |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8319 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8320 | acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 |
| 8321 | block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl |
| 8322 | block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT |
| 8323 | block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8324 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8325 | To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site |
| 8326 | and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts : |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8327 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8328 | acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css |
| 8329 | acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js |
| 8330 | acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www |
| 8331 | acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp. |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8332 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8333 | # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls |
| 8334 | # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest. |
| 8335 | use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static |
| 8336 | use_backend www if host_www |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8337 | |
Willy Tarreau | 95fa469 | 2010-02-01 13:05:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8338 | It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL |
| 8339 | expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must |
| 8340 | be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because |
| 8341 | the braces must be seen as independant words). Example : |
| 8342 | |
| 8343 | The following rule : |
| 8344 | |
| 8345 | acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 |
| 8346 | block if METH_POST missing_cl |
| 8347 | |
| 8348 | Can also be written that way : |
| 8349 | |
| 8350 | block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 } |
| 8351 | |
| 8352 | It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier |
| 8353 | to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very |
| 8354 | simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more |
| 8355 | sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of |
| 8356 | good use is the following : |
| 8357 | |
| 8358 | With named ACLs : |
| 8359 | |
| 8360 | acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 |
| 8361 | acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2 |
| 8362 | monitor fail if site_dead |
| 8363 | |
| 8364 | With anonymous ACLs : |
| 8365 | |
| 8366 | monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 } |
| 8367 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8368 | See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords. |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8369 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5764b38 | 2007-11-30 17:46:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8370 | |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8371 | 7.8. Pattern extraction |
| 8372 | ----------------------- |
| 8373 | |
| 8374 | The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and |
| 8375 | response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored, |
| 8376 | for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case. |
| 8377 | |
| 8378 | All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as |
| 8379 | "pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It |
| 8380 | begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of |
| 8381 | arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As |
| 8382 | much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their |
| 8383 | equivalent used in ACLs. |
| 8384 | |
| 8385 | The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following : |
| 8386 | |
| 8387 | src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. |
David du Colombier | 9a6d3c9 | 2011-03-17 10:40:24 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8388 | It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. |
| 8389 | On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, |
| 8390 | according to RFC 4291. |
| 8391 | |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8392 | dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the |
| 8393 | client side, which is the address the client connected to. |
| 8394 | It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of |
David du Colombier | 9a6d3c9 | 2011-03-17 10:40:24 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8395 | type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. |
| 8396 | On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, |
| 8397 | according to RFC 4291. |
| 8398 | |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8399 | dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client |
| 8400 | side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be |
| 8401 | used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic |
| 8402 | ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of |
| 8403 | type integer and only works with such tables. |
| 8404 | |
Willy Tarreau | 185b5c4 | 2012-04-26 15:11:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8405 | hdr(<name>[,<occ>]) |
| 8406 | This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP |
| 8407 | request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as |
| 8408 | a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the |
| 8409 | first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values |
| 8410 | indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the |
| 8411 | last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once |
Willy Tarreau | e428fb7 | 2011-12-16 21:50:30 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8412 | converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. |
Willy Tarreau | 4a56897 | 2010-05-12 08:08:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8413 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8414 | payload(<offset>,<length>) |
Emeric Brun | 6a1cefa | 2010-09-24 18:15:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8415 | This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting |
| 8416 | at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request |
| 8417 | on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store |
| 8418 | response"). |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8419 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8420 | payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) |
Emeric Brun | 6a1cefa | 2010-09-24 18:15:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8421 | This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the |
| 8422 | block is read from response or request buffer at <offset> |
| 8423 | bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step |
| 8424 | data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes |
| 8425 | (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>). |
| 8426 | If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to |
| 8427 | <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute. |
| 8428 | Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter. |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8429 | |
Willy Tarreau | 25c1ebc | 2012-04-25 16:21:44 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8430 | src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side, |
| 8431 | which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely |
| 8432 | that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost. |
| 8433 | It is of type integer and only works with such tables. |
| 8434 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8435 | url_param(<name>) |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8436 | This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in |
| 8437 | the query string of the request and uses the corresponding value |
| 8438 | to match. A typical use is to get sticky session through url |
| 8439 | (e.g. http://example.com/foo?JESSIONID=some_id with |
| 8440 | url_param(JSESSIONID)), for cases where cookies cannot be used. |
David Cournapeau | 16023ee | 2010-12-23 20:55:41 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 8441 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8442 | rdp_cookie(<name>) |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8443 | This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string |
| 8444 | and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of |
| 8445 | persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically |
| 8446 | done if there is no msts cookie present. |
Simon Horman | ab814e0 | 2011-06-24 14:50:20 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 8447 | |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8448 | This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing |
| 8449 | algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients |
| 8450 | to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP |
| 8451 | cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm |
| 8452 | such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will |
| 8453 | lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend |
| 8454 | servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie". |
Simon Horman | ab814e0 | 2011-06-24 14:50:20 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 8455 | |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8456 | Example : |
| 8457 | listen tse-farm |
| 8458 | bind 0.0.0.0:3389 |
| 8459 | # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request |
| 8460 | tcp-request inspect-delay 5s |
| 8461 | tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE |
| 8462 | # apply RDP cookie persistence |
| 8463 | persist rdp-cookie |
| 8464 | # Persist based on the mstshash cookie |
| 8465 | # This is only useful makes sense if |
| 8466 | # balance rdp-cookie is not used |
| 8467 | stick-table type string size 204800 |
| 8468 | stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash) |
| 8469 | server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389 |
| 8470 | server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389 |
Simon Horman | ab814e0 | 2011-06-24 14:50:20 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 8471 | |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8472 | See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", |
| 8473 | "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL. |
Simon Horman | ab814e0 | 2011-06-24 14:50:20 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 8474 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8475 | cookie(<name>) |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8476 | This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a |
Willy Tarreau | 28376d6 | 2012-04-26 21:26:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8477 | "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header |
| 8478 | from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A |
| 8479 | typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile |
| 8480 | use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession" |
| 8481 | does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for |
| 8482 | multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. |
Willy Tarreau | b3eb221 | 2011-07-01 16:16:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8483 | |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8484 | See also : "appsession" |
Willy Tarreau | b3eb221 | 2011-07-01 16:16:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8485 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8486 | set-cookie(<name>) |
Willy Tarreau | 28376d6 | 2012-04-26 21:26:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8487 | This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the |
| 8488 | "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and |
| 8489 | responses. This keyword will disappear soon. |
| 8490 | |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8491 | This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a |
| 8492 | "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the |
| 8493 | corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what |
| 8494 | "appsession" does with default options, but with support for |
| 8495 | multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. |
Willy Tarreau | b3eb221 | 2011-07-01 16:16:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8496 | |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8497 | See also : "appsession" |
Willy Tarreau | b3eb221 | 2011-07-01 16:16:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8498 | |
Simon Horman | ab814e0 | 2011-06-24 14:50:20 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 8499 | |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8500 | The currently available list of transformations include : |
| 8501 | |
| 8502 | lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed |
| 8503 | after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion |
| 8504 | function returning a string type. The result is of type string. |
| 8505 | |
| 8506 | upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed |
| 8507 | after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion |
| 8508 | function returning a string type. The result is of type string. |
| 8509 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8510 | ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups |
Willy Tarreau | d31d6eb | 2010-01-26 18:01:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8511 | and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a |
| 8512 | certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use |
| 8513 | the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg: |
| 8514 | 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24). |
| 8515 | |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8516 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8517 | 8. Logging |
| 8518 | ---------- |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8519 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8520 | One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably |
| 8521 | provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is |
| 8522 | very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information |
| 8523 | provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session |
| 8524 | state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8525 | to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8526 | headers. |
| 8527 | |
| 8528 | In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency |
| 8529 | about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to |
| 8530 | send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters : |
| 8531 | |
| 8532 | - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..) |
| 8533 | - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...) |
| 8534 | - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections) |
| 8535 | - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or |
| 8536 | at the termination. |
| 8537 | |
| 8538 | The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers |
| 8539 | allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon |
| 8540 | as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors, |
| 8541 | while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in |
| 8542 | real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour |
| 8543 | delay. |
| 8544 | |
| 8545 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8546 | 8.1. Log levels |
| 8547 | --------------- |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8548 | |
Simon Horman | df791f5 | 2011-05-29 15:01:10 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 8549 | TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time, |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8550 | source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times, |
Simon Horman | df791f5 | 2011-05-29 15:01:10 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 8551 | HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions |
| 8552 | in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example |
| 8553 | track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two |
| 8554 | syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information |
| 8555 | about log facilities. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8556 | |
| 8557 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8558 | 8.2. Log formats |
| 8559 | ---------------- |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8560 | |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8561 | HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats |
Simon Horman | df791f5 | 2011-05-29 15:01:10 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 8562 | and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary |
| 8563 | slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain |
| 8564 | options. The supported formats are as follows : |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8565 | |
| 8566 | - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only |
| 8567 | provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment |
| 8568 | it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name. |
| 8569 | This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great |
| 8570 | extents. |
| 8571 | |
| 8572 | - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option |
| 8573 | tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the |
| 8574 | connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer |
| 8575 | information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This |
| 8576 | format is recommended for pure TCP proxies. |
| 8577 | |
| 8578 | - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format |
| 8579 | is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the |
| 8580 | same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as |
| 8581 | the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This |
| 8582 | format is recommended for HTTP proxies. |
| 8583 | |
Emeric Brun | 3a058f3 | 2009-06-30 18:26:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8584 | - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the |
| 8585 | fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all |
| 8586 | timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the |
| 8587 | common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format. |
| 8588 | |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8589 | - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line. |
| 8590 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8591 | Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format |
| 8592 | specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a |
| 8593 | field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog |
| 8594 | servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is |
| 8595 | always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and |
| 8596 | identifier. |
| 8597 | |
| 8598 | Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below |
| 8599 | might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be |
| 8600 | prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is |
| 8601 | broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a |
| 8602 | backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters. |
| 8603 | |
| 8604 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8605 | 8.2.1. Default log format |
| 8606 | ------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8607 | |
| 8608 | This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon |
| 8609 | as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only |
| 8610 | format which logs the request's destination IP and ports. |
| 8611 | |
| 8612 | Example : |
| 8613 | listen www |
| 8614 | mode http |
| 8615 | log global |
| 8616 | server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 |
| 8617 | |
| 8618 | >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \ |
| 8619 | haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \ |
| 8620 | (www/HTTP) |
| 8621 | |
| 8622 | Field Format Extract from the example above |
| 8623 | 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]: |
| 8624 | 2 'Connect from' Connect from |
| 8625 | 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312 |
| 8626 | 4 'to' to |
| 8627 | 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012 |
| 8628 | 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP) |
| 8629 | |
| 8630 | Detailed fields description : |
| 8631 | - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection. |
| 8632 | - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection. |
| 8633 | - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to. |
| 8634 | - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to. |
| 8635 | - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received |
| 8636 | and processed the connection. |
| 8637 | - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP). |
| 8638 | |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8639 | In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as |
| 8640 | "unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the |
| 8641 | connection (the same ID as reported in the stats). |
| 8642 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8643 | It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it |
| 8644 | will eventually disappear. |
| 8645 | |
| 8646 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8647 | 8.2.2. TCP log format |
| 8648 | --------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8649 | |
| 8650 | The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and |
| 8651 | is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious |
| 8652 | information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte |
| 8653 | counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be |
| 8654 | emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most |
| 8655 | environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match |
| 8656 | the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for |
| 8657 | sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by |
Willy Tarreau | c9bd0cc | 2009-05-10 11:57:02 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8658 | specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will |
| 8659 | not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few |
| 8660 | fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are |
| 8661 | marked with a star ('*') after the field name below. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8662 | |
| 8663 | Example : |
| 8664 | frontend fnt |
| 8665 | mode tcp |
| 8666 | option tcplog |
| 8667 | log global |
| 8668 | default_backend bck |
| 8669 | |
| 8670 | backend bck |
| 8671 | server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 |
| 8672 | |
| 8673 | >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \ |
| 8674 | haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \ |
| 8675 | bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0 |
| 8676 | |
| 8677 | Field Format Extract from the example above |
| 8678 | 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]: |
| 8679 | 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313 |
| 8680 | 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] |
| 8681 | 4 frontend_name fnt |
| 8682 | 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1 |
| 8683 | 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007 |
| 8684 | 7 bytes_read* 212 |
| 8685 | 8 termination_state -- |
| 8686 | 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3 |
| 8687 | 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0 |
| 8688 | |
| 8689 | Detailed fields description : |
| 8690 | - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8691 | connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket |
| 8692 | instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that |
| 8693 | when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy" |
| 8694 | and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the |
| 8695 | forwarded connection's information. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8696 | |
| 8697 | - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection. |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8698 | If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be |
| 8699 | replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the |
| 8700 | stats interface. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8701 | |
| 8702 | - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy |
| 8703 | (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the |
| 8704 | network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually |
| 8705 | the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. |
| 8706 | |
| 8707 | - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received |
| 8708 | and processed the connection. |
| 8709 | |
| 8710 | - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected |
| 8711 | to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the |
| 8712 | frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP |
| 8713 | applications. |
| 8714 | |
| 8715 | - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was |
| 8716 | sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors |
| 8717 | and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend |
| 8718 | which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching |
| 8719 | a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. |
| 8720 | |
| 8721 | - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues. |
| 8722 | It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue. |
| 8723 | See "Timers" below for more details. |
| 8724 | |
| 8725 | - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to |
| 8726 | establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the |
| 8727 | connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See |
| 8728 | "Timers" below for more details. |
| 8729 | |
| 8730 | - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the |
| 8731 | last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if |
| 8732 | "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment |
| 8733 | the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value, |
| 8734 | indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more |
| 8735 | details. |
| 8736 | |
| 8737 | - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to |
| 8738 | the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the |
| 8739 | this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one |
| 8740 | may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log |
| 8741 | analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing. |
| 8742 | |
| 8743 | - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session |
| 8744 | ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of |
| 8745 | session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal |
| 8746 | flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with |
| 8747 | no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection" |
| 8748 | for more details. |
| 8749 | |
| 8750 | - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when |
| 8751 | the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system |
| 8752 | limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when |
| 8753 | multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits |
| 8754 | the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8755 | are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8756 | |
| 8757 | - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when |
| 8758 | the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource |
| 8759 | required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn" |
| 8760 | has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is |
| 8761 | because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be |
| 8762 | caused by a denial of service attack. |
| 8763 | |
| 8764 | - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the |
| 8765 | backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of |
| 8766 | concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of |
| 8767 | connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of |
| 8768 | additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application. |
| 8769 | Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is |
| 8770 | congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a |
| 8771 | denial of service attack. |
| 8772 | |
| 8773 | - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on |
| 8774 | the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's |
| 8775 | configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal |
| 8776 | to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a |
| 8777 | lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that |
| 8778 | there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response |
| 8779 | time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means |
| 8780 | that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to |
| 8781 | be processed than on other servers. |
| 8782 | |
| 8783 | - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session |
| 8784 | when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a |
| 8785 | server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted. |
| 8786 | Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between |
| 8787 | haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server |
| 8788 | preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be |
| 8789 | prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a |
| 8790 | redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial |
| 8791 | server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the |
| 8792 | connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may |
| 8793 | sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule |
| 8794 | of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count |
| 8795 | should not be attributed to the logged server. |
| 8796 | |
| 8797 | - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before |
| 8798 | this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone |
| 8799 | through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate |
| 8800 | server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of |
| 8801 | requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a |
| 8802 | redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be |
| 8803 | cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the |
| 8804 | backend queue unless a redispatch occurs. |
| 8805 | |
| 8806 | - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before |
| 8807 | this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not |
| 8808 | gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average |
| 8809 | queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when |
| 8810 | divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a |
| 8811 | session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue, |
| 8812 | and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass |
| 8813 | through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch |
| 8814 | occurs. |
| 8815 | |
| 8816 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8817 | 8.2.3. HTTP log format |
| 8818 | ---------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8819 | |
| 8820 | The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It |
| 8821 | is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides |
| 8822 | the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which |
| 8823 | are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually |
| 8824 | emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which |
| 8825 | generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the |
| 8826 | "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for |
| 8827 | which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the |
Willy Tarreau | c9bd0cc | 2009-05-10 11:57:02 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8828 | frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" |
| 8829 | is specified in the frontend. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8830 | |
| 8831 | Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may |
| 8832 | slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked |
| 8833 | with a star ('*') after the field name below. |
| 8834 | |
| 8835 | Example : |
| 8836 | frontend http-in |
| 8837 | mode http |
| 8838 | option httplog |
| 8839 | log global |
| 8840 | default_backend bck |
| 8841 | |
| 8842 | backend static |
| 8843 | server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 |
| 8844 | |
| 8845 | >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \ |
| 8846 | haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \ |
| 8847 | static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \ |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8848 | {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8849 | |
| 8850 | Field Format Extract from the example above |
| 8851 | 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]: |
| 8852 | 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317 |
| 8853 | 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] |
| 8854 | 4 frontend_name http-in |
| 8855 | 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1 |
| 8856 | 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109 |
| 8857 | 7 status_code 200 |
| 8858 | 8 bytes_read* 2750 |
| 8859 | 9 captured_request_cookie - |
| 8860 | 10 captured_response_cookie - |
| 8861 | 11 termination_state ---- |
| 8862 | 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0 |
| 8863 | 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0 |
| 8864 | 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu} |
| 8865 | 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {} |
| 8866 | 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8867 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8868 | |
| 8869 | Detailed fields description : |
| 8870 | - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8871 | connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket |
| 8872 | instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that |
| 8873 | when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy" |
| 8874 | and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the |
| 8875 | forwarded connection's information. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8876 | |
| 8877 | - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection. |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8878 | If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be |
| 8879 | replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the |
| 8880 | stats interface. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8881 | |
| 8882 | - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by |
| 8883 | haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on |
| 8884 | the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is |
| 8885 | usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This |
| 8886 | does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not. |
| 8887 | |
| 8888 | - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received |
| 8889 | and processed the connection. |
| 8890 | |
| 8891 | - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected |
| 8892 | to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the |
| 8893 | frontend if no switching rule has been applied. |
| 8894 | |
| 8895 | - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was |
| 8896 | sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors |
| 8897 | and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend |
| 8898 | which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a |
| 8899 | server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was |
| 8900 | intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead. |
| 8901 | |
| 8902 | - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send |
| 8903 | a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection |
| 8904 | was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always |
| 8905 | be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large |
| 8906 | times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and |
| 8907 | haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details. |
| 8908 | |
| 8909 | - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues. |
| 8910 | It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue. |
| 8911 | See "Timers" below for more details. |
| 8912 | |
| 8913 | - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to |
| 8914 | establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the |
| 8915 | request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers" |
| 8916 | below for more details. |
| 8917 | |
| 8918 | - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send |
| 8919 | a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was |
| 8920 | aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches |
| 8921 | the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by |
| 8922 | the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on |
| 8923 | "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below |
| 8924 | for more details. |
| 8925 | |
| 8926 | - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the |
| 8927 | last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if |
| 8928 | "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment |
| 8929 | the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value, |
| 8930 | indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more |
| 8931 | details. |
| 8932 | |
| 8933 | - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status |
| 8934 | is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when |
| 8935 | the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy. |
| 8936 | |
| 8937 | - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when |
| 8938 | the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is |
| 8939 | specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that |
| 8940 | the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit |
| 8941 | counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without |
| 8942 | overflowing. |
| 8943 | |
| 8944 | - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that |
| 8945 | the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum |
| 8946 | length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend |
| 8947 | configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not |
| 8948 | set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session |
| 8949 | ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing |
| 8950 | between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult |
| 8951 | the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below. |
| 8952 | |
| 8953 | - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating |
| 8954 | that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name |
| 8955 | and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the |
| 8956 | frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is |
| 8957 | not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track |
| 8958 | session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session |
| 8959 | crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please |
| 8960 | consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below. |
| 8961 | |
| 8962 | - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session |
| 8963 | ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of |
| 8964 | session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP |
| 8965 | logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last |
| 8966 | two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the |
| 8967 | session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See |
| 8968 | below "Session state at disconnection" for more details. |
| 8969 | |
| 8970 | - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when |
| 8971 | the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system |
| 8972 | limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024 |
| 8973 | when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system |
| 8974 | limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8975 | of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8976 | system. |
| 8977 | |
| 8978 | - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when |
| 8979 | the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource |
| 8980 | required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn" |
| 8981 | has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is |
| 8982 | because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be |
| 8983 | caused by a denial of service attack. |
| 8984 | |
| 8985 | - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the |
| 8986 | backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of |
| 8987 | concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of |
| 8988 | connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of |
| 8989 | additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application. |
| 8990 | Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is |
| 8991 | congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a |
| 8992 | denial of service attack. |
| 8993 | |
| 8994 | - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on |
| 8995 | the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's |
| 8996 | configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal |
| 8997 | to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a |
| 8998 | lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that |
| 8999 | there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response |
| 9000 | time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means |
| 9001 | that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be |
| 9002 | processed than on other servers. |
| 9003 | |
| 9004 | - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session |
| 9005 | when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a |
| 9006 | server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted. |
| 9007 | Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between |
| 9008 | haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server |
| 9009 | preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be |
| 9010 | prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a |
| 9011 | redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial |
| 9012 | server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the |
| 9013 | connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may |
| 9014 | sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule |
| 9015 | of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count |
| 9016 | should not be attributed to the logged server. |
| 9017 | |
| 9018 | - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before |
| 9019 | this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone |
| 9020 | through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate |
| 9021 | server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of |
| 9022 | requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a |
| 9023 | redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be |
| 9024 | cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the |
| 9025 | backend queue unless a redispatch occurs. |
| 9026 | |
| 9027 | - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before |
| 9028 | this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not |
| 9029 | gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average |
| 9030 | queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when |
| 9031 | divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a |
| 9032 | session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue, |
| 9033 | and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass |
| 9034 | through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch |
| 9035 | occurs. |
| 9036 | |
| 9037 | - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due |
| 9038 | to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend. |
| 9039 | Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar |
| 9040 | ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a |
| 9041 | shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may |
| 9042 | contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when |
| 9043 | it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and |
| 9044 | cookies" below for more details. |
| 9045 | |
| 9046 | - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response |
| 9047 | due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the |
| 9048 | frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a |
| 9049 | vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, |
| 9050 | causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this |
| 9051 | field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser |
| 9052 | than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers |
| 9053 | and cookies" below for more details. |
| 9054 | |
| 9055 | - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method, |
| 9056 | request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see |
| 9057 | below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last |
| 9058 | field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can |
| 9059 | contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be |
| 9060 | added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is |
| 9061 | huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This |
| 9062 | is the reason why this field must always remain the last one. |
| 9063 | |
| 9064 | |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9065 | 8.2.4. Custom log format |
| 9066 | ------------------------ |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9067 | |
William Lallemand | bddd4fd | 2012-02-27 11:23:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9068 | The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp |
| 9069 | mode. It takes a string as argument. |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9070 | |
| 9071 | HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables. |
| 9072 | Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are |
| 9073 | separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by |
| 9074 | prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign. |
| 9075 | |
| 9076 | Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other |
| 9077 | variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted |
| 9078 | string formats ("Q"). |
| 9079 | |
| 9080 | Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator. |
| 9081 | HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators. |
| 9082 | |
| 9083 | Flags are : |
| 9084 | * Q: quote a string |
William Lallemand | 5f23240 | 2012-04-05 18:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9085 | * X: hexadecimal represenation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid) |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9086 | |
| 9087 | Example: |
| 9088 | |
| 9089 | log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text |
| 9090 | log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r |
| 9091 | |
| 9092 | At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way : |
| 9093 | |
| 9094 | log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \ |
Willy Tarreau | 6580c06 | 2012-03-12 15:09:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9095 | %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9096 | |
William Lallemand | bddd4fd | 2012-02-27 11:23:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9097 | the default CLF format is defined this way : |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9098 | |
| 9099 | log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \ |
Willy Tarreau | 6580c06 | 2012-03-12 15:09:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9100 | %ms\ %f\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \ |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9101 | %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl |
| 9102 | |
William Lallemand | bddd4fd | 2012-02-27 11:23:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9103 | and the default TCP format is defined this way : |
| 9104 | |
| 9105 | log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \ |
| 9106 | %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq |
| 9107 | |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9108 | Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables : |
| 9109 | |
William Lallemand | bddd4fd | 2012-02-27 11:23:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9110 | +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+ |
| 9111 | | H | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type | |
| 9112 | +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+ |
| 9113 | | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | | |
| 9114 | +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+ |
| 9115 | | | %B | bytes_read | numeric | |
William Lallemand | 5f23240 | 2012-04-05 18:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9116 | | | %Ci | client_ip | IP | |
William Lallemand | bddd4fd | 2012-02-27 11:23:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9117 | | | %Cp | client_port | numeric | |
William Lallemand | 5f23240 | 2012-04-05 18:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9118 | | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | IP | |
William Lallemand | b7ff6a3 | 2012-03-02 14:35:21 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9119 | | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric | |
William Lallemand | 5f23240 | 2012-04-05 18:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9120 | | | %Fi | frontend_ip | IP | |
| 9121 | | | %Fp | frontend_port | numeric | |
| 9122 | | | %H | hostname | string | |
William Lallemand | a73203e | 2012-03-12 12:48:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9123 | | | %ID | unique-id | string | |
William Lallemand | 5f23240 | 2012-04-05 18:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9124 | | | %Si | server_IP | IP | |
| 9125 | | | %Sp | server_port | numeric | |
| 9126 | | | %T | gmt_date_time | date | |
William Lallemand | bddd4fd | 2012-02-27 11:23:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9127 | | | %Tc | Tc | numeric | |
| 9128 | | * | %Tq | Tq | numeric | |
| 9129 | | * | %Tr | Tr | numeric | |
William Lallemand | 5f23240 | 2012-04-05 18:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9130 | | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric | |
William Lallemand | bddd4fd | 2012-02-27 11:23:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9131 | | | %Tt | Tt | numeric | |
| 9132 | | | %Tw | Tw | numeric | |
| 9133 | | | %ac | actconn | numeric | |
| 9134 | | | %b | backend_name | string | |
| 9135 | | | %bc | beconn | numeric | |
| 9136 | | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric | |
| 9137 | | * | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string | |
William Lallemand | 5f23240 | 2012-04-05 18:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9138 | | * | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric | |
William Lallemand | bddd4fd | 2012-02-27 11:23:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9139 | | * | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string | |
| 9140 | | | %f | frontend_name | string | |
| 9141 | | | %fc | feconn | numeric | |
| 9142 | | * | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string | |
| 9143 | | * | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list | |
| 9144 | | * | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string | |
| 9145 | | * | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list | |
| 9146 | | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric | |
William Lallemand | 5f23240 | 2012-04-05 18:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9147 | | | %pid | PID | numeric | |
William Lallemand | bddd4fd | 2012-02-27 11:23:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9148 | | * | %r | http_request | string | |
| 9149 | | | %rc | retries | numeric | |
| 9150 | | | %s | server_name | string | |
| 9151 | | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric | |
| 9152 | | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric | |
| 9153 | | * | %st | status_code | numeric | |
William Lallemand | 5f23240 | 2012-04-05 18:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9154 | | | %t | date_time | date | |
William Lallemand | bddd4fd | 2012-02-27 11:23:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9155 | | | %ts | termination_state | string | |
Willy Tarreau | 6580c06 | 2012-03-12 15:09:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9156 | | * | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string | |
William Lallemand | bddd4fd | 2012-02-27 11:23:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9157 | +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+ |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9158 | |
William Lallemand | 5f23240 | 2012-04-05 18:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9159 | *: mode http only |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9160 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9161 | 8.3. Advanced logging options |
| 9162 | ----------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9163 | |
| 9164 | Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out |
| 9165 | just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few |
| 9166 | options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference |
| 9167 | for more information about their usage. |
| 9168 | |
| 9169 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9170 | 8.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests |
| 9171 | ------------------------------------------ |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9172 | |
| 9173 | It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on |
| 9174 | haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any |
| 9175 | commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete |
| 9176 | monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often |
| 9177 | ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities : |
| 9178 | |
| 9179 | - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often |
| 9180 | desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by |
| 9181 | setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of |
| 9182 | port scans, which may or may not be desired. |
| 9183 | |
| 9184 | - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to |
| 9185 | declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then |
| 9186 | only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be |
| 9187 | logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments |
| 9188 | such as other load-balancers. |
| 9189 | |
| 9190 | - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare |
| 9191 | this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will |
| 9192 | only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged. |
| 9193 | |
| 9194 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9195 | 8.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate |
| 9196 | ---------------------------------------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9197 | |
| 9198 | The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about |
| 9199 | what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions |
| 9200 | or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying |
| 9201 | "option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible, |
| 9202 | just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still |
| 9203 | log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just |
| 9204 | after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported |
| 9205 | is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion |
| 9206 | with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed |
| 9207 | with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger. |
| 9208 | |
| 9209 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9210 | 8.3.3. Raising log level upon errors |
| 9211 | ------------------------------------ |
Willy Tarreau | c9bd0cc | 2009-05-10 11:57:02 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9212 | |
| 9213 | Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs, |
| 9214 | for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option |
| 9215 | "log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts, |
| 9216 | retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level |
| 9217 | raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in |
| 9218 | a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic |
| 9219 | file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if |
| 9220 | you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than |
| 9221 | "notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice". |
| 9222 | |
| 9223 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9224 | 8.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections |
| 9225 | -------------------------------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | c9bd0cc | 2009-05-10 11:57:02 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9226 | |
| 9227 | Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with |
| 9228 | multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping |
| 9229 | them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option |
| 9230 | "dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be |
| 9231 | logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any |
| 9232 | error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too, |
| 9233 | and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged |
| 9234 | too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the |
| 9235 | useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other |
| 9236 | alternative. |
| 9237 | |
| 9238 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9239 | 8.4. Timing events |
| 9240 | ------------------ |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9241 | |
| 9242 | Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are |
| 9243 | reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with |
| 9244 | the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the |
| 9245 | frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP |
| 9246 | mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" : |
| 9247 | |
| 9248 | - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time |
| 9249 | elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the |
| 9250 | moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates |
| 9251 | that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when |
| 9252 | the client closes prematurely or times out. |
| 9253 | |
| 9254 | - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It |
| 9255 | accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the |
| 9256 | queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous |
| 9257 | requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching |
| 9258 | the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests. |
| 9259 | |
| 9260 | - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time |
| 9261 | elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the |
| 9262 | moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and |
| 9263 | the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the |
| 9264 | connection never established. |
| 9265 | |
| 9266 | - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between |
| 9267 | the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment |
| 9268 | the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request |
| 9269 | processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission. |
| 9270 | It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for |
| 9271 | instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort |
| 9272 | apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust |
| 9273 | too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an |
| 9274 | untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response |
| 9275 | header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout |
| 9276 | stroke before the server managed to process the request. |
| 9277 | |
| 9278 | - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it |
| 9279 | and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap" |
| 9280 | option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is |
| 9281 | prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data |
| 9282 | transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid : |
| 9283 | |
| 9284 | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) |
| 9285 | |
| 9286 | Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP |
| 9287 | mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be |
| 9288 | negative. |
| 9289 | |
| 9290 | These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP |
| 9291 | protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure |
| 9292 | that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9293 | due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9294 | close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a |
| 9295 | session has been aborted on timeout. |
| 9296 | |
| 9297 | Most common cases : |
| 9298 | |
| 9299 | - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the |
| 9300 | client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen |
| 9301 | when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may |
| 9302 | happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause. |
| 9303 | Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended, |
| 9304 | haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time |
| 9305 | spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing |
| 9306 | of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of |
| 9307 | a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new |
Patrick Mezard | 105faca | 2010-06-12 17:02:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9308 | connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close" |
| 9309 | may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent |
| 9310 | waiting for additional requests. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9311 | |
| 9312 | - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the |
| 9313 | server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should |
| 9314 | always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens |
| 9315 | of ms on remote networks. |
| 9316 | |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9317 | - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem |
| 9318 | to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost |
| 9319 | between the proxy and the server. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9320 | |
| 9321 | - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because |
| 9322 | neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for |
| 9323 | instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order |
| 9324 | to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on |
| 9325 | either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that |
| 9326 | the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to |
| 9327 | close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the |
| 9328 | smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with |
| 9329 | the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent |
| 9330 | to the server until another one is released. |
| 9331 | |
| 9332 | Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) : |
| 9333 | |
| 9334 | Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log |
| 9335 | was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid |
| 9336 | except "Tt" which is shorter than reality. |
| 9337 | |
| 9338 | -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time |
| 9339 | or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags |
| 9340 | then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings. |
| 9341 | |
| 9342 | Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because |
| 9343 | servers were out of order, because the request was invalid |
| 9344 | or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination |
| 9345 | flags. |
| 9346 | |
| 9347 | Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it |
| 9348 | actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms. |
| 9349 | Check the session termination flags, then check the |
| 9350 | "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might |
| 9351 | return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time |
| 9352 | the client connection was maintained open. |
| 9353 | |
| 9354 | Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return |
| 9355 | a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion |
| 9356 | unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session |
| 9357 | termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting. |
| 9358 | |
| 9359 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9360 | 8.5. Session state at disconnection |
| 9361 | ----------------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9362 | |
| 9363 | TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the |
| 9364 | "termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is |
| 9365 | 2-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode, |
| 9366 | each of which has a special meaning : |
| 9367 | |
| 9368 | - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the |
| 9369 | session to terminate : |
| 9370 | |
| 9371 | C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client. |
| 9372 | |
| 9373 | S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the |
| 9374 | server explicitly refused it. |
| 9375 | |
| 9376 | P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a |
| 9377 | connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched, |
| 9378 | because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous |
| 9379 | error in server response which might have caused information leak |
| 9380 | (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by |
| 9381 | the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...). |
| 9382 | |
| 9383 | R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source |
| 9384 | ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and |
| 9385 | system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this |
| 9386 | happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which |
| 9387 | should be fixed as soon as possible by any means. |
| 9388 | |
| 9389 | I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check. |
| 9390 | This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log |
| 9391 | containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It |
| 9392 | would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an |
| 9393 | event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption. |
| 9394 | |
Simon Horman | 752dc4a | 2011-06-21 14:34:59 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 9395 | D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected |
| 9396 | as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down. |
| 9397 | |
Willy Tarreau | a2a64e9 | 2011-09-07 23:01:56 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9398 | K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy. |
| 9399 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9400 | c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to |
| 9401 | send or receive data. |
| 9402 | |
| 9403 | s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to |
| 9404 | send or receive data. |
| 9405 | |
| 9406 | - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed |
| 9407 | with nothing left in the buffers. |
| 9408 | |
| 9409 | - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed : |
| 9410 | |
Willy Tarreau | f7b30a9 | 2010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9411 | R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9412 | (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server. |
| 9413 | |
| 9414 | Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can |
| 9415 | only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can |
| 9416 | also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to |
| 9417 | a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is |
| 9418 | reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server. |
| 9419 | |
| 9420 | C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the |
| 9421 | server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt. |
| 9422 | |
| 9423 | H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the |
| 9424 | server (HTTP only). |
| 9425 | |
| 9426 | D : the session was in the DATA phase. |
| 9427 | |
| 9428 | L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the |
| 9429 | server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only |
| 9430 | happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets. |
| 9431 | |
| 9432 | T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client |
| 9433 | during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client |
| 9434 | closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer. |
| 9435 | |
| 9436 | - : normal session completion after end of data transfer. |
| 9437 | |
| 9438 | - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by |
| 9439 | the client (only in HTTP mode) : |
| 9440 | |
| 9441 | N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new |
| 9442 | visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the |
| 9443 | logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation. |
| 9444 | |
| 9445 | I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server. |
| 9446 | This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed |
Cyril Bonté | a8e7bbc | 2010-04-25 22:29:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9447 | cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally |
| 9448 | ignored, or an attack. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9449 | |
| 9450 | D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN, |
| 9451 | so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to |
| 9452 | this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to |
| 9453 | another server. |
| 9454 | |
Willy Tarreau | 996a92c | 2010-10-13 19:30:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9455 | V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9456 | server. |
| 9457 | |
Willy Tarreau | 996a92c | 2010-10-13 19:30:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9458 | E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was |
| 9459 | older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so |
| 9460 | the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be |
| 9461 | redispatched just as if there was no cookie. |
| 9462 | |
| 9463 | O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was |
| 9464 | older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so |
| 9465 | the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be |
| 9466 | redispatched just as if there was no cookie. |
| 9467 | |
Willy Tarreau | c89ccb6 | 2012-04-05 21:18:22 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9468 | U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because |
| 9469 | some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a |
| 9470 | "use-server" rule). |
| 9471 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9472 | - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration). |
| 9473 | |
| 9474 | - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence |
| 9475 | cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) : |
| 9476 | |
| 9477 | N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either. |
| 9478 | |
| 9479 | I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one. |
| 9480 | Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie, |
| 9481 | it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here. |
| 9482 | |
Willy Tarreau | 996a92c | 2010-10-13 19:30:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9483 | U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by |
| 9484 | the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It |
| 9485 | happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the |
| 9486 | date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as |
| 9487 | a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead. |
| 9488 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9489 | P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is. |
| 9490 | |
| 9491 | R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which |
| 9492 | happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes. |
| 9493 | |
| 9494 | D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy. |
| 9495 | |
| 9496 | - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration). |
| 9497 | |
Willy Tarreau | 996a92c | 2010-10-13 19:30:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9498 | The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what |
| 9499 | was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9500 | helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource |
| 9501 | starvation, attacks, etc... |
| 9502 | |
| 9503 | The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are |
| 9504 | alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for |
| 9505 | easier finding and understanding. |
| 9506 | |
| 9507 | Flags Reason |
| 9508 | |
| 9509 | -- Normal termination. |
| 9510 | |
| 9511 | CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the |
| 9512 | server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently |
| 9513 | dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is |
| 9514 | waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire. |
| 9515 | |
| 9516 | CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be |
| 9517 | caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the |
| 9518 | client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection, |
| 9519 | by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a |
| 9520 | keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first |
| 9521 | by the client. |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9522 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9523 | cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the |
| 9524 | "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9525 | the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9526 | |
| 9527 | CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding. |
| 9528 | It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client |
| 9529 | clicking the 'Stop' button too fast. |
| 9530 | |
| 9531 | cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a |
| 9532 | POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values |
| 9533 | for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can |
| 9534 | also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and |
| 9535 | the server takes too long to respond. |
| 9536 | |
| 9537 | CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server |
| 9538 | with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the |
| 9539 | servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too |
| 9540 | long a time to respond. |
| 9541 | |
| 9542 | CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely |
| 9543 | the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted |
| 9544 | too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this |
| 9545 | might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy |
| 9546 | and the client. |
| 9547 | |
| 9548 | cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP |
| 9549 | request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the |
| 9550 | client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized |
| 9551 | packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast |
| 9552 | enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the |
| 9553 | request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. |
| 9554 | |
| 9555 | CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to |
| 9556 | check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9557 | wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it |
| 9558 | might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something |
| 9559 | closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume |
| 9560 | resources for just a few attackers. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9561 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9562 | SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9563 | the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message |
| 9564 | in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network |
| 9565 | stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route, |
| 9566 | or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode, |
| 9567 | the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here. |
| 9568 | |
| 9569 | sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could |
| 9570 | complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a |
| 9571 | 503 or 504 here. |
| 9572 | |
| 9573 | SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data |
| 9574 | transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from |
| 9575 | the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while |
| 9576 | exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash |
| 9577 | or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment. |
| 9578 | |
| 9579 | sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the |
| 9580 | "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9581 | by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls, |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9582 | load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained |
| 9583 | between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy. |
| 9584 | |
| 9585 | SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or |
| 9586 | it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at |
| 9587 | this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to |
| 9588 | control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a |
| 9589 | small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application. |
| 9590 | Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection |
| 9591 | between haproxy and the server. |
| 9592 | |
| 9593 | sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its |
| 9594 | response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too |
| 9595 | long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation. |
| 9596 | The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server" |
| 9597 | setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience |
| 9598 | will suffer from these long response times. The only long term |
| 9599 | solution is to fix the application. |
| 9600 | |
| 9601 | sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See |
| 9602 | the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to |
| 9603 | fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in |
| 9604 | short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected |
| 9605 | servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by |
| 9606 | external attacks. |
| 9607 | |
| 9608 | PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the |
| 9609 | process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect. |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9610 | The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9611 | so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and |
| 9612 | might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand. |
| 9613 | |
Willy Tarreau | ed2fd2d | 2010-12-29 11:23:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9614 | PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in |
| 9615 | a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In |
| 9616 | most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to |
| 9617 | the client. |
| 9618 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9619 | PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid, |
| 9620 | incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter. |
| 9621 | In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible |
| 9622 | cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name |
Willy Tarreau | ed2fd2d | 2010-12-29 11:23:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9623 | containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite |
| 9624 | rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the |
| 9625 | client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this |
| 9626 | case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the |
| 9627 | logs. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9628 | |
| 9629 | PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an |
| 9630 | invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to |
| 9631 | the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it |
| 9632 | returned an HTTP 403 error. |
| 9633 | |
| 9634 | PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its |
| 9635 | connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent |
| 9636 | to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as |
| 9637 | reported by the "Tw" timer field. |
| 9638 | |
| 9639 | RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports) |
| 9640 | preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error |
| 9641 | logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can |
| 9642 | only be solved by proper system tuning. |
| 9643 | |
Willy Tarreau | 996a92c | 2010-10-13 19:30:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9644 | The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how |
| 9645 | persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very |
| 9646 | important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to |
| 9647 | re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are : |
| 9648 | |
| 9649 | -- Persistence cookie is not enabled. |
| 9650 | |
| 9651 | NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the |
| 9652 | response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly" |
| 9653 | set on a GET request. |
| 9654 | |
| 9655 | II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client, |
| 9656 | a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when |
| 9657 | a "server" entry is removed from the configuraton, since its cookie |
| 9658 | value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it. |
| 9659 | |
| 9660 | NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the |
| 9661 | response. This typically happens for first requests from every user |
| 9662 | in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users. |
| 9663 | |
| 9664 | VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the |
| 9665 | response. This happens for most responses for which the client has |
| 9666 | already got a cookie. |
| 9667 | |
| 9668 | VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is |
| 9669 | not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in |
| 9670 | response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if |
| 9671 | there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the |
| 9672 | cookie can be switched to unlimited time. |
| 9673 | |
| 9674 | EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is |
| 9675 | too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a |
| 9676 | new cookie was inserted in the response. |
| 9677 | |
| 9678 | OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is |
| 9679 | too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a |
| 9680 | new cookie was inserted in the response. |
| 9681 | |
| 9682 | DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was |
| 9683 | selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response. |
| 9684 | |
| 9685 | VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not |
| 9686 | be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was |
| 9687 | then advertised in the response. |
| 9688 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9689 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9690 | 8.6. Non-printable characters |
| 9691 | ----------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9692 | |
| 9693 | In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log |
| 9694 | consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are |
| 9695 | converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code, |
| 9696 | prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without |
| 9697 | being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the |
| 9698 | escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It |
| 9699 | is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and |
| 9700 | '}' when logging headers. |
| 9701 | |
| 9702 | Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause |
| 9703 | issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header |
| 9704 | containing spaces is "User-Agent". |
| 9705 | |
| 9706 | Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape |
| 9707 | the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be |
| 9708 | performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs. |
| 9709 | |
| 9710 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9711 | 8.7. Capturing HTTP cookies |
| 9712 | --------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9713 | |
| 9714 | Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be |
| 9715 | achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9716 | section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9717 | cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in |
| 9718 | the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in |
| 9719 | the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie" |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9720 | locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9721 | not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a |
| 9722 | user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it |
| 9723 | a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a |
| 9724 | wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing. |
| 9725 | |
| 9726 | Examples : |
| 9727 | # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION" |
| 9728 | capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32 |
| 9729 | |
| 9730 | # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor" |
| 9731 | capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32 |
| 9732 | |
| 9733 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9734 | 8.8. Capturing HTTP headers |
| 9735 | --------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9736 | |
| 9737 | Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper |
| 9738 | proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In |
| 9739 | the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the |
| 9740 | server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection. |
| 9741 | |
| 9742 | Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture |
| 9743 | response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9744 | section 4.2 for more details. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9745 | |
| 9746 | It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9747 | time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header |
| 9748 | appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9749 | are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared, |
| 9750 | and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers |
| 9751 | follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the |
| 9752 | request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request |
| 9753 | in the logs. |
| 9754 | |
| 9755 | Example : |
| 9756 | # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy |
| 9757 | listen proxy-out |
| 9758 | mode http |
| 9759 | option httplog |
| 9760 | option logasap |
| 9761 | log global |
| 9762 | server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128 |
| 9763 | |
| 9764 | # log the name of the virtual server |
| 9765 | capture request header Host len 20 |
| 9766 | |
| 9767 | # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST |
| 9768 | capture request header Content-Length len 10 |
| 9769 | |
| 9770 | # log the beginning of the referrer |
| 9771 | capture request header Referer len 20 |
| 9772 | |
| 9773 | # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only) |
| 9774 | capture response header Server len 20 |
| 9775 | |
| 9776 | # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap" |
| 9777 | capture response header Content-Length len 10 |
| 9778 | |
| 9779 | # log the expected cache behaviour on the response |
| 9780 | capture response header Cache-Control len 8 |
| 9781 | |
| 9782 | # the Via header will report the next proxy's name |
| 9783 | capture response header Via len 20 |
| 9784 | |
| 9785 | # log the URL location during a redirection |
| 9786 | capture response header Location len 20 |
| 9787 | |
| 9788 | >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \ |
| 9789 | haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \ |
| 9790 | proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \ |
| 9791 | {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \ |
| 9792 | "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/" |
| 9793 | |
| 9794 | >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \ |
| 9795 | haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \ |
| 9796 | proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \ |
| 9797 | {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \ |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9798 | "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1" |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9799 | |
| 9800 | >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \ |
| 9801 | haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \ |
| 9802 | proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \ |
| 9803 | {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \ |
| 9804 | {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \ |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9805 | "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1" |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9806 | |
| 9807 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9808 | 8.9. Examples of logs |
| 9809 | --------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9810 | |
| 9811 | These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of |
| 9812 | them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better |
| 9813 | reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them. |
| 9814 | |
| 9815 | >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \ |
| 9816 | px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \ |
| 9817 | "HEAD / HTTP/1.0" |
| 9818 | |
| 9819 | => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied |
| 9820 | in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----') |
| 9821 | |
| 9822 | >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \ |
| 9823 | px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \ |
| 9824 | 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0" |
| 9825 | |
| 9826 | => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other |
| 9827 | requests, and waited there for 1230 ms. |
| 9828 | |
| 9829 | >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \ |
| 9830 | px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \ |
| 9831 | "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0" |
| 9832 | |
| 9833 | => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9834 | the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9835 | 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from |
| 9836 | accept to first data byte is 30 ms. |
| 9837 | |
| 9838 | >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \ |
| 9839 | px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \ |
| 9840 | "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0" |
| 9841 | |
| 9842 | => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or |
| 9843 | "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and |
Willy Tarreau | 3c92c5f | 2011-08-28 09:45:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9844 | not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9845 | risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 |
| 9846 | bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided |
| 9847 | to return the 502 and not the server. |
| 9848 | |
| 9849 | >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \ |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9850 | px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 "" |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9851 | |
| 9852 | => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after |
| 9853 | 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--"). |
| 9854 | Nothing was sent to any server. |
| 9855 | |
| 9856 | >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \ |
| 9857 | px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 "" |
| 9858 | |
| 9859 | => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the |
| 9860 | time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request |
| 9861 | headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could |
| 9862 | send a 408 return code to the client. |
| 9863 | |
| 9864 | >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \ |
| 9865 | px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 |
| 9866 | |
| 9867 | => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after |
| 9868 | 5 seconds ("c----"). |
| 9869 | |
| 9870 | >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \ |
| 9871 | px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \ |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9872 | 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0" |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9873 | |
| 9874 | => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9875 | connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9876 | (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have |
| 9877 | seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115 |
| 9878 | connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on |
| 9879 | the global process. It is possible that the server refused the |
| 9880 | connection because of too many already established. |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9881 | |
Willy Tarreau | 3dfe6cd | 2008-12-07 22:29:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9882 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9883 | 9. Statistics and monitoring |
| 9884 | ---------------------------- |
| 9885 | |
| 9886 | It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used |
| 9887 | mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative |
| 9888 | CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the |
| 9889 | Unix socket. |
| 9890 | |
| 9891 | |
| 9892 | 9.1. CSV format |
Willy Tarreau | 3dfe6cd | 2008-12-07 22:29:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9893 | --------------- |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f58a962 | 2008-02-23 01:19:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9894 | |
Willy Tarreau | 7f062c4 | 2009-03-05 18:43:00 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9895 | The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP |
| 9896 | page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. |
| 9897 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f58a962 | 2008-02-23 01:19:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9898 | 0. pxname: proxy name |
| 9899 | 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name |
| 9900 | for server) |
| 9901 | 2. qcur: current queued requests |
| 9902 | 3. qmax: max queued requests |
| 9903 | 4. scur: current sessions |
| 9904 | 5. smax: max sessions |
| 9905 | 6. slim: sessions limit |
| 9906 | 7. stot: total sessions |
| 9907 | 8. bin: bytes in |
| 9908 | 9. bout: bytes out |
| 9909 | 10. dreq: denied requests |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 2c6962c | 2008-03-02 02:42:14 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9910 | 11. dresp: denied responses |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f58a962 | 2008-02-23 01:19:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9911 | 12. ereq: request errors |
| 9912 | 13. econ: connection errors |
Willy Tarreau | ae52678 | 2010-03-04 20:34:23 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9913 | 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt) |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f58a962 | 2008-02-23 01:19:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9914 | 15. wretr: retries (warning) |
| 9915 | 16. wredis: redispatches (warning) |
Cyril Bonté | 0dae585 | 2010-02-03 00:26:28 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9916 | 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...) |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f58a962 | 2008-02-23 01:19:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9917 | 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend) |
| 9918 | 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend) |
| 9919 | 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend) |
| 9920 | 21. chkfail: number of failed checks |
| 9921 | 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions |
| 9922 | 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds) |
| 9923 | 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds) |
| 9924 | 25. qlimit: queue limit |
| 9925 | 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...) |
| 9926 | 27. iid: unique proxy id |
| 9927 | 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy) |
| 9928 | 29. throttle: warm up status |
| 9929 | 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected |
| 9930 | 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | aeebf9b | 2009-10-04 15:43:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9931 | 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket) |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | db57c6b | 2009-08-31 21:23:27 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9932 | 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second |
| 9933 | 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second |
| 9934 | 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 0960541 | 2009-09-23 22:09:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9935 | 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of: |
Cyril Bonté | f0c6061 | 2010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9936 | UNK -> unknown |
| 9937 | INI -> initializing |
| 9938 | SOCKERR -> socket error |
| 9939 | L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled |
| 9940 | L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout |
| 9941 | L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example |
| 9942 | "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp) |
| 9943 | L6OK -> check passed on layer 6 |
| 9944 | L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout |
| 9945 | L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error |
| 9946 | L7OK -> check passed on layer 7 |
| 9947 | L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with |
| 9948 | disable-on-404 |
| 9949 | L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout |
| 9950 | L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error |
| 9951 | L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 0960541 | 2009-09-23 22:09:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9952 | 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available |
| 9953 | 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9954 | 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code |
| 9955 | 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code |
| 9956 | 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code |
| 9957 | 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code |
| 9958 | 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code |
| 9959 | 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error) |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9960 | 45. hanafail: failed health checks details |
| 9961 | 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second |
| 9962 | 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed |
| 9963 | 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received |
Willy Tarreau | ae52678 | 2010-03-04 20:34:23 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9964 | 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client |
| 9965 | 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp) |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9966 | |
Willy Tarreau | 3dfe6cd | 2008-12-07 22:29:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9967 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9968 | 9.2. Unix Socket commands |
Willy Tarreau | 3dfe6cd | 2008-12-07 22:29:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9969 | ------------------------- |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 2c6962c | 2008-03-02 02:42:14 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9970 | |
Willy Tarreau | 3dfe6cd | 2008-12-07 22:29:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9971 | The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them |
Willy Tarreau | 9a42c0d | 2009-09-22 19:31:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9972 | must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it |
| 9973 | is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by |
| 9974 | a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no |
| 9975 | risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be |
| 9976 | followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a |
| 9977 | given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed |
| 9978 | then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines |
| 9979 | to be issued one at a time. |
Willy Tarreau | 3dfe6cd | 2008-12-07 22:29:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9980 | |
Willy Tarreau | 9a42c0d | 2009-09-22 19:31:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9981 | It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started |
| 9982 | on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its |
| 9983 | own stats. |
Willy Tarreau | 3dfe6cd | 2008-12-07 22:29:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9984 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9985 | clear counters |
| 9986 | Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & |
| 9987 | backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This |
| 9988 | can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to |
| 9989 | restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can |
| 9990 | only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin". |
| 9991 | |
| 9992 | clear counters all |
| 9993 | Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each |
| 9994 | server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted |
| 9995 | and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". |
| 9996 | |
Simon Horman | c88b887 | 2011-06-15 15:18:49 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 9997 | clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ] |
| 9998 | Remove entries from the stick-table <table>. |
| 9999 | |
| 10000 | This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been |
| 10001 | abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some |
| 10002 | stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show |
| 10003 | table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be |
| 10004 | refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds |
| 10005 | later after the session ends is usual enough. |
| 10006 | |
| 10007 | In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed. |
| 10008 | |
| 10009 | When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the |
| 10010 | stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data |
| 10011 | type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the |
| 10012 | table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to |
| 10013 | <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with |
| 10014 | the ACLs : |
| 10015 | |
| 10016 | - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value |
| 10017 | - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value |
| 10018 | - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value |
| 10019 | - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value |
| 10020 | - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value |
| 10021 | - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value |
| 10022 | |
| 10023 | When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the |
Simon Horman | 619e3cc | 2011-06-15 15:18:52 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10024 | same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and |
| 10025 | string. |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10026 | |
| 10027 | Example : |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10028 | $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 |
Emeric Brun | 7c6b82e | 2010-09-24 16:34:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10029 | >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2 |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10030 | >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \ |
| 10031 | bytes_out_rate(60000)=187 |
| 10032 | >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \ |
| 10033 | bytes_out_rate(60000)=191 |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10034 | |
| 10035 | $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 |
| 10036 | |
| 10037 | $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 |
Emeric Brun | 7c6b82e | 2010-09-24 16:34:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10038 | >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1 |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10039 | >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \ |
| 10040 | bytes_out_rate(60000)=191 |
Simon Horman | c88b887 | 2011-06-15 15:18:49 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10041 | $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 |
| 10042 | $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 |
| 10043 | >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1 |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10044 | |
Willy Tarreau | 532a450 | 2011-09-07 22:37:44 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10045 | disable frontend <frontend> |
| 10046 | Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which |
| 10047 | is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be |
| 10048 | enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes |
| 10049 | are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments |
| 10050 | where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must |
| 10051 | be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another |
| 10052 | process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP" |
| 10053 | on the stats page. |
| 10054 | |
| 10055 | The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID, |
| 10056 | prefixed with a sharp ('#'). |
| 10057 | |
| 10058 | This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for |
| 10059 | level "admin". |
| 10060 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10061 | disable server <backend>/<server> |
| 10062 | Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be |
| 10063 | performed on the server until it leaves maintenance. |
| 10064 | If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN |
| 10065 | during the maintenance. |
| 10066 | |
| 10067 | In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a |
| 10068 | "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one. |
| 10069 | |
| 10070 | Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by |
Willy Tarreau | f5f3192 | 2011-08-02 11:32:07 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10071 | their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#'). |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10072 | |
| 10073 | This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for |
| 10074 | level "admin". |
| 10075 | |
Willy Tarreau | 532a450 | 2011-09-07 22:37:44 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10076 | enable frontend <frontend> |
| 10077 | Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of |
| 10078 | the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process |
| 10079 | took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error |
| 10080 | is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend |
| 10081 | which was disabled. |
| 10082 | |
| 10083 | The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID, |
| 10084 | prefixed with a sharp ('#'). |
| 10085 | |
| 10086 | This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for |
| 10087 | level "admin". |
| 10088 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10089 | enable server <backend>/<server> |
| 10090 | If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the |
| 10091 | server UP and checks are re-enabled. |
| 10092 | |
| 10093 | Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by |
Willy Tarreau | f5f3192 | 2011-08-02 11:32:07 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10094 | their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#'). |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10095 | |
| 10096 | This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for |
| 10097 | level "admin". |
| 10098 | |
| 10099 | get weight <backend>/<server> |
| 10100 | Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in |
| 10101 | backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is |
| 10102 | the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal |
| 10103 | unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server |
| 10104 | may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a |
Willy Tarreau | f5f3192 | 2011-08-02 11:32:07 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10105 | sharp ('#'). |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10106 | |
Willy Tarreau | 9a42c0d | 2009-09-22 19:31:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10107 | help |
| 10108 | Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen |
| 10109 | is also displayed for unknown commands. |
Willy Tarreau | 3dfe6cd | 2008-12-07 22:29:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10110 | |
Willy Tarreau | 9a42c0d | 2009-09-22 19:31:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10111 | prompt |
| 10112 | Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive |
| 10113 | mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command |
| 10114 | completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that |
| 10115 | the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right |
| 10116 | angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient |
| 10117 | when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors. |
| 10118 | It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help" |
| 10119 | command. |
| 10120 | |
| 10121 | quit |
| 10122 | Close the connection when in interactive mode. |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 2c6962c | 2008-03-02 02:42:14 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10123 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2a0f4d2 | 2011-08-02 11:49:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10124 | set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value> |
| 10125 | Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any non-null |
| 10126 | positive value is allowed, but setting values larger than the global maxconn |
| 10127 | does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections were |
| 10128 | pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below |
| 10129 | the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be |
| 10130 | delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by |
| 10131 | either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#'). |
| 10132 | |
Willy Tarreau | 91886b6 | 2011-09-07 14:38:31 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10133 | set maxconn global <maxconn> |
| 10134 | Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the |
| 10135 | initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were |
| 10136 | pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below |
| 10137 | the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be |
| 10138 | delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial |
| 10139 | setting. |
| 10140 | |
Willy Tarreau | f5b2287 | 2011-09-07 16:13:44 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10141 | set rate-limit connections global <value> |
| 10142 | Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global |
| 10143 | 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit |
| 10144 | applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value |
| 10145 | is passed in number of connections per second. |
| 10146 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10147 | set timeout cli <delay> |
| 10148 | Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful |
| 10149 | during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect |
| 10150 | some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds. |
| 10151 | |
| 10152 | set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%] |
| 10153 | Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends |
| 10154 | with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially |
| 10155 | configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%, |
| 10156 | and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part |
| 10157 | of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations |
| 10158 | because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only |
| 10159 | accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take |
| 10160 | effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of |
| 10161 | requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable |
| 10162 | a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it |
| 10163 | again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted |
| 10164 | and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the |
| 10165 | backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their |
Willy Tarreau | f5f3192 | 2011-08-02 11:32:07 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10166 | numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#'). |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10167 | |
Willy Tarreau | e0c8a1a | 2009-03-04 16:33:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10168 | show errors [<iid>] |
| 10169 | Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and |
| 10170 | backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning |
Willy Tarreau | 6162db2 | 2009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10171 | either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted |
| 10172 | and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or |
| 10173 | "admin". |
Willy Tarreau | e0c8a1a | 2009-03-04 16:33:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10174 | |
| 10175 | The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors |
| 10176 | caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header |
| 10177 | names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the |
| 10178 | protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was |
| 10179 | detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the |
| 10180 | internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session |
| 10181 | are reported too. |
| 10182 | |
| 10183 | All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The |
| 10184 | most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one |
| 10185 | letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to |
| 10186 | avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where |
| 10187 | NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII |
| 10188 | code. |
| 10189 | |
| 10190 | Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0 |
| 10191 | for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line, |
| 10192 | and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that |
| 10193 | the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a |
| 10194 | line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset |
| 10195 | will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous |
| 10196 | line. |
| 10197 | |
| 10198 | Example : |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10199 | $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 |
| 10200 | >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response |
Willy Tarreau | e0c8a1a | 2009-03-04 16:33:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10201 | src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1) |
| 10202 | response length 213 bytes, error at position 23: |
| 10203 | |
| 10204 | 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n |
| 10205 | 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n |
| 10206 | 00038 Location: blah\r\n |
| 10207 | 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b |
| 10208 | 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer, |
| 10209 | 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter |
| 10210 | 00204+ minal\r\n |
| 10211 | 00211 \r\n |
| 10212 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10213 | In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal |
Willy Tarreau | e0c8a1a | 2009-03-04 16:33:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10214 | ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal |
| 10215 | ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and |
| 10216 | received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was |
| 10217 | 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This |
| 10218 | is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid |
| 10219 | HTTP character for a header name. |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 2c6962c | 2008-03-02 02:42:14 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10220 | |
Willy Tarreau | 9a42c0d | 2009-09-22 19:31:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10221 | show info |
| 10222 | Dump info about haproxy status on current process. |
| 10223 | |
| 10224 | show sess |
| 10225 | Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can |
Willy Tarreau | 6162db2 | 2009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10226 | be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets |
| 10227 | configured for levels "operator" or "admin". |
| 10228 | |
Willy Tarreau | 66dc20a | 2010-03-05 17:53:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10229 | show sess <id> |
| 10230 | Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier. |
| 10231 | This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps |
| 10232 | of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are |
| 10233 | useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a |
| 10234 | complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can |
| 10235 | freely evolve depending on demands. |
Willy Tarreau | 9a42c0d | 2009-09-22 19:31:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10236 | |
| 10237 | show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>] |
| 10238 | Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is |
| 10239 | possible to dump only selected items : |
| 10240 | - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything |
| 10241 | - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for |
| 10242 | backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed, |
| 10243 | for example: |
| 10244 | 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend. |
| 10245 | 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server. |
| 10246 | - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy. |
| 10247 | |
| 10248 | Example : |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10249 | $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1 |
| 10250 | >>> Name: HAProxy |
Willy Tarreau | 9a42c0d | 2009-09-22 19:31:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10251 | Version: 1.4-dev2-49 |
| 10252 | Release_date: 2009/09/23 |
| 10253 | Nbproc: 1 |
| 10254 | Process_num: 1 |
| 10255 | (...) |
| 10256 | |
| 10257 | # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...) |
| 10258 | stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...) |
| 10259 | stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...) |
| 10260 | (...) |
| 10261 | www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...) |
| 10262 | |
| 10263 | $ |
| 10264 | |
| 10265 | Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find |
| 10266 | which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty |
| 10267 | line after the information output which marks the end of the first block. |
| 10268 | A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10269 | the reader knows the output has not been truncated. |
Willy Tarreau | 9a42c0d | 2009-09-22 19:31:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10270 | |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10271 | show table |
| 10272 | Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned |
| 10273 | (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always |
| 10274 | IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of |
| 10275 | entries currently in use. |
| 10276 | |
| 10277 | Example : |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10278 | $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 |
Simon Horman | 64b28d0 | 2011-08-13 08:03:50 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10279 | >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454 |
| 10280 | >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0 |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10281 | |
Simon Horman | 17bce34 | 2011-06-15 15:18:47 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10282 | show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ] |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10283 | Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic |
| 10284 | information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all |
| 10285 | entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify |
Simon Horman | 17bce34 | 2011-06-15 15:18:47 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10286 | a filter in order to specify what entries to display. |
| 10287 | |
| 10288 | When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see |
| 10289 | "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified |
| 10290 | in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an |
| 10291 | error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the |
| 10292 | 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs : |
| 10293 | |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10294 | - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value |
| 10295 | - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value |
| 10296 | - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value |
| 10297 | - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value |
| 10298 | - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value |
| 10299 | - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value |
| 10300 | |
Simon Horman | c88b887 | 2011-06-15 15:18:49 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10301 | |
| 10302 | When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the |
Simon Horman | 619e3cc | 2011-06-15 15:18:52 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10303 | same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer, |
| 10304 | and string. |
Simon Horman | 17bce34 | 2011-06-15 15:18:47 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10305 | |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10306 | Example : |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10307 | $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 |
Simon Horman | 64b28d0 | 2011-08-13 08:03:50 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10308 | >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2 |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10309 | >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \ |
| 10310 | bytes_out_rate(60000)=187 |
| 10311 | >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \ |
| 10312 | bytes_out_rate(60000)=191 |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10313 | |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10314 | $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 |
Simon Horman | 64b28d0 | 2011-08-13 08:03:50 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10315 | >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2 |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10316 | >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \ |
| 10317 | bytes_out_rate(60000)=191 |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10318 | |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10319 | $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \ |
| 10320 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 |
Simon Horman | 64b28d0 | 2011-08-13 08:03:50 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10321 | >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2 |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10322 | >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \ |
| 10323 | bytes_out_rate(60000)=191 |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10324 | |
Simon Horman | 17bce34 | 2011-06-15 15:18:47 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10325 | $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \ |
| 10326 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 |
Simon Horman | 64b28d0 | 2011-08-13 08:03:50 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10327 | >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2 |
Simon Horman | 17bce34 | 2011-06-15 15:18:47 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10328 | >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \ |
| 10329 | bytes_out_rate(60000)=191 |
| 10330 | |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10331 | When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as |
| 10332 | a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the |
| 10333 | entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that |
| 10334 | such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as |
| 10335 | time goes, the average event rate drops. |
| 10336 | |
| 10337 | It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the |
| 10338 | service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall. |
| 10339 | Example : |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10340 | $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \ |
| 10341 | | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \ |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10342 | | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt |
| 10343 | ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' ) |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 719e726 | 2009-10-04 15:02:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10344 | |
Willy Tarreau | 532a450 | 2011-09-07 22:37:44 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10345 | shutdown frontend <frontend> |
| 10346 | Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will |
| 10347 | be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after |
| 10348 | this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a |
| 10349 | proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That |
| 10350 | way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to |
| 10351 | restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page |
| 10352 | once it is terminated. |
| 10353 | |
| 10354 | The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID, |
| 10355 | prefixed with a sharp ('#'). |
| 10356 | |
| 10357 | This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for |
| 10358 | level "admin". |
| 10359 | |
Willy Tarreau | a295edc | 2011-09-07 23:21:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10360 | shutdown session <id> |
| 10361 | Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier. |
| 10362 | This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps |
| 10363 | of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to |
| 10364 | terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an |
| 10365 | endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K' |
| 10366 | flag in the logs. |
| 10367 | |
Willy Tarreau | 52b2d22 | 2011-09-07 23:48:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10368 | shutdown sessions <backend>/<server> |
| 10369 | Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This |
| 10370 | can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into |
| 10371 | maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a |
| 10372 | 'K' flag in the logs. |
| 10373 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10374 | /* |
| 10375 | * Local variables: |
| 10376 | * fill-column: 79 |
| 10377 | * End: |
| 10378 | */ |